1 //===---- TargetInfo.cpp - Encapsulate target details -----------*- C++ -*-===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // These classes wrap the information about a call or function 10 // definition used to handle ABI compliancy. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "TargetInfo.h" 15 #include "ABIInfo.h" 16 #include "CGBlocks.h" 17 #include "CGCXXABI.h" 18 #include "CGValue.h" 19 #include "CodeGenFunction.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h" 21 #include "clang/Basic/CodeGenOptions.h" 22 #include "clang/CodeGen/CGFunctionInfo.h" 23 #include "clang/CodeGen/SwiftCallingConv.h" 24 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h" 25 #include "llvm/ADT/StringSwitch.h" 26 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 27 #include "llvm/ADT/Twine.h" 28 #include "llvm/IR/DataLayout.h" 29 #include "llvm/IR/Type.h" 30 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h" 31 #include <algorithm> // std::sort 32 33 using namespace clang; 34 using namespace CodeGen; 35 36 // Helper for coercing an aggregate argument or return value into an integer 37 // array of the same size (including padding) and alignment. This alternate 38 // coercion happens only for the RenderScript ABI and can be removed after 39 // runtimes that rely on it are no longer supported. 40 // 41 // RenderScript assumes that the size of the argument / return value in the IR 42 // is the same as the size of the corresponding qualified type. This helper 43 // coerces the aggregate type into an array of the same size (including 44 // padding). This coercion is used in lieu of expansion of struct members or 45 // other canonical coercions that return a coerced-type of larger size. 46 // 47 // Ty - The argument / return value type 48 // Context - The associated ASTContext 49 // LLVMContext - The associated LLVMContext 50 static ABIArgInfo coerceToIntArray(QualType Ty, 51 ASTContext &Context, 52 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext) { 53 // Alignment and Size are measured in bits. 54 const uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 55 const uint64_t Alignment = Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 56 llvm::Type *IntType = llvm::Type::getIntNTy(LLVMContext, Alignment); 57 const uint64_t NumElements = (Size + Alignment - 1) / Alignment; 58 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(IntType, NumElements)); 59 } 60 61 static void AssignToArrayRange(CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder, 62 llvm::Value *Array, 63 llvm::Value *Value, 64 unsigned FirstIndex, 65 unsigned LastIndex) { 66 // Alternatively, we could emit this as a loop in the source. 67 for (unsigned I = FirstIndex; I <= LastIndex; ++I) { 68 llvm::Value *Cell = 69 Builder.CreateConstInBoundsGEP1_32(Builder.getInt8Ty(), Array, I); 70 Builder.CreateAlignedStore(Value, Cell, CharUnits::One()); 71 } 72 } 73 74 static bool isAggregateTypeForABI(QualType T) { 75 return !CodeGenFunction::hasScalarEvaluationKind(T) || 76 T->isMemberFunctionPointerType(); 77 } 78 79 ABIArgInfo 80 ABIInfo::getNaturalAlignIndirect(QualType Ty, bool ByRef, bool Realign, 81 llvm::Type *Padding) const { 82 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty), 83 ByRef, Realign, Padding); 84 } 85 86 ABIArgInfo 87 ABIInfo::getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(QualType Ty, bool Realign) const { 88 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirectInReg(getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty), 89 /*ByRef*/ false, Realign); 90 } 91 92 Address ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 93 QualType Ty) const { 94 return Address::invalid(); 95 } 96 97 ABIInfo::~ABIInfo() {} 98 99 /// Does the given lowering require more than the given number of 100 /// registers when expanded? 101 /// 102 /// This is intended to be the basis of a reasonable basic implementation 103 /// of should{Pass,Return}IndirectlyForSwift. 104 /// 105 /// For most targets, a limit of four total registers is reasonable; this 106 /// limits the amount of code required in order to move around the value 107 /// in case it wasn't produced immediately prior to the call by the caller 108 /// (or wasn't produced in exactly the right registers) or isn't used 109 /// immediately within the callee. But some targets may need to further 110 /// limit the register count due to an inability to support that many 111 /// return registers. 112 static bool occupiesMoreThan(CodeGenTypes &cgt, 113 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalarTypes, 114 unsigned maxAllRegisters) { 115 unsigned intCount = 0, fpCount = 0; 116 for (llvm::Type *type : scalarTypes) { 117 if (type->isPointerTy()) { 118 intCount++; 119 } else if (auto intTy = dyn_cast<llvm::IntegerType>(type)) { 120 auto ptrWidth = cgt.getTarget().getPointerWidth(0); 121 intCount += (intTy->getBitWidth() + ptrWidth - 1) / ptrWidth; 122 } else { 123 assert(type->isVectorTy() || type->isFloatingPointTy()); 124 fpCount++; 125 } 126 } 127 128 return (intCount + fpCount > maxAllRegisters); 129 } 130 131 bool SwiftABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits vectorSize, 132 llvm::Type *eltTy, 133 unsigned numElts) const { 134 // The default implementation of this assumes that the target guarantees 135 // 128-bit SIMD support but nothing more. 136 return (vectorSize.getQuantity() > 8 && vectorSize.getQuantity() <= 16); 137 } 138 139 static CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI getRecordArgABI(const RecordType *RT, 140 CGCXXABI &CXXABI) { 141 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 142 if (!RD) { 143 if (!RT->getDecl()->canPassInRegisters()) 144 return CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect; 145 return CGCXXABI::RAA_Default; 146 } 147 return CXXABI.getRecordArgABI(RD); 148 } 149 150 static CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI getRecordArgABI(QualType T, 151 CGCXXABI &CXXABI) { 152 const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 153 if (!RT) 154 return CGCXXABI::RAA_Default; 155 return getRecordArgABI(RT, CXXABI); 156 } 157 158 static bool classifyReturnType(const CGCXXABI &CXXABI, CGFunctionInfo &FI, 159 const ABIInfo &Info) { 160 QualType Ty = FI.getReturnType(); 161 162 if (const auto *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) 163 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()) && 164 !RT->getDecl()->canPassInRegisters()) { 165 FI.getReturnInfo() = Info.getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty); 166 return true; 167 } 168 169 return CXXABI.classifyReturnType(FI); 170 } 171 172 /// Pass transparent unions as if they were the type of the first element. Sema 173 /// should ensure that all elements of the union have the same "machine type". 174 static QualType useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(QualType Ty) { 175 if (const RecordType *UT = Ty->getAsUnionType()) { 176 const RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 177 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) { 178 assert(!UD->field_empty() && "sema created an empty transparent union"); 179 return UD->field_begin()->getType(); 180 } 181 } 182 return Ty; 183 } 184 185 CGCXXABI &ABIInfo::getCXXABI() const { 186 return CGT.getCXXABI(); 187 } 188 189 ASTContext &ABIInfo::getContext() const { 190 return CGT.getContext(); 191 } 192 193 llvm::LLVMContext &ABIInfo::getVMContext() const { 194 return CGT.getLLVMContext(); 195 } 196 197 const llvm::DataLayout &ABIInfo::getDataLayout() const { 198 return CGT.getDataLayout(); 199 } 200 201 const TargetInfo &ABIInfo::getTarget() const { 202 return CGT.getTarget(); 203 } 204 205 const CodeGenOptions &ABIInfo::getCodeGenOpts() const { 206 return CGT.getCodeGenOpts(); 207 } 208 209 bool ABIInfo::isAndroid() const { return getTarget().getTriple().isAndroid(); } 210 211 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 212 return false; 213 } 214 215 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base, 216 uint64_t Members) const { 217 return false; 218 } 219 220 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void ABIArgInfo::dump() const { 221 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 222 OS << "(ABIArgInfo Kind="; 223 switch (TheKind) { 224 case Direct: 225 OS << "Direct Type="; 226 if (llvm::Type *Ty = getCoerceToType()) 227 Ty->print(OS); 228 else 229 OS << "null"; 230 break; 231 case Extend: 232 OS << "Extend"; 233 break; 234 case Ignore: 235 OS << "Ignore"; 236 break; 237 case InAlloca: 238 OS << "InAlloca Offset=" << getInAllocaFieldIndex(); 239 break; 240 case Indirect: 241 OS << "Indirect Align=" << getIndirectAlign().getQuantity() 242 << " ByVal=" << getIndirectByVal() 243 << " Realign=" << getIndirectRealign(); 244 break; 245 case Expand: 246 OS << "Expand"; 247 break; 248 case CoerceAndExpand: 249 OS << "CoerceAndExpand Type="; 250 getCoerceAndExpandType()->print(OS); 251 break; 252 } 253 OS << ")\n"; 254 } 255 256 // Dynamically round a pointer up to a multiple of the given alignment. 257 static llvm::Value *emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 258 llvm::Value *Ptr, 259 CharUnits Align) { 260 llvm::Value *PtrAsInt = Ptr; 261 // OverflowArgArea = (OverflowArgArea + Align - 1) & -Align; 262 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(PtrAsInt, CGF.IntPtrTy); 263 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(PtrAsInt, 264 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.IntPtrTy, Align.getQuantity() - 1)); 265 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(PtrAsInt, 266 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.IntPtrTy, -Align.getQuantity())); 267 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(PtrAsInt, 268 Ptr->getType(), 269 Ptr->getName() + ".aligned"); 270 return PtrAsInt; 271 } 272 273 /// Emit va_arg for a platform using the common void* representation, 274 /// where arguments are simply emitted in an array of slots on the stack. 275 /// 276 /// This version implements the core direct-value passing rules. 277 /// 278 /// \param SlotSize - The size and alignment of a stack slot. 279 /// Each argument will be allocated to a multiple of this number of 280 /// slots, and all the slots will be aligned to this value. 281 /// \param AllowHigherAlign - The slot alignment is not a cap; 282 /// an argument type with an alignment greater than the slot size 283 /// will be emitted on a higher-alignment address, potentially 284 /// leaving one or more empty slots behind as padding. If this 285 /// is false, the returned address might be less-aligned than 286 /// DirectAlign. 287 static Address emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 288 Address VAListAddr, 289 llvm::Type *DirectTy, 290 CharUnits DirectSize, 291 CharUnits DirectAlign, 292 CharUnits SlotSize, 293 bool AllowHigherAlign) { 294 // Cast the element type to i8* if necessary. Some platforms define 295 // va_list as a struct containing an i8* instead of just an i8*. 296 if (VAListAddr.getElementType() != CGF.Int8PtrTy) 297 VAListAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(VAListAddr, CGF.Int8PtrTy); 298 299 llvm::Value *Ptr = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "argp.cur"); 300 301 // If the CC aligns values higher than the slot size, do so if needed. 302 Address Addr = Address::invalid(); 303 if (AllowHigherAlign && DirectAlign > SlotSize) { 304 Addr = Address(emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, Ptr, DirectAlign), 305 DirectAlign); 306 } else { 307 Addr = Address(Ptr, SlotSize); 308 } 309 310 // Advance the pointer past the argument, then store that back. 311 CharUnits FullDirectSize = DirectSize.alignTo(SlotSize); 312 Address NextPtr = 313 CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, FullDirectSize, "argp.next"); 314 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NextPtr.getPointer(), VAListAddr); 315 316 // If the argument is smaller than a slot, and this is a big-endian 317 // target, the argument will be right-adjusted in its slot. 318 if (DirectSize < SlotSize && CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && 319 !DirectTy->isStructTy()) { 320 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, SlotSize - DirectSize); 321 } 322 323 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, DirectTy); 324 return Addr; 325 } 326 327 /// Emit va_arg for a platform using the common void* representation, 328 /// where arguments are simply emitted in an array of slots on the stack. 329 /// 330 /// \param IsIndirect - Values of this type are passed indirectly. 331 /// \param ValueInfo - The size and alignment of this type, generally 332 /// computed with getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(ValueTy). 333 /// \param SlotSizeAndAlign - The size and alignment of a stack slot. 334 /// Each argument will be allocated to a multiple of this number of 335 /// slots, and all the slots will be aligned to this value. 336 /// \param AllowHigherAlign - The slot alignment is not a cap; 337 /// an argument type with an alignment greater than the slot size 338 /// will be emitted on a higher-alignment address, potentially 339 /// leaving one or more empty slots behind as padding. 340 static Address emitVoidPtrVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 341 QualType ValueTy, bool IsIndirect, 342 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> ValueInfo, 343 CharUnits SlotSizeAndAlign, 344 bool AllowHigherAlign) { 345 // The size and alignment of the value that was passed directly. 346 CharUnits DirectSize, DirectAlign; 347 if (IsIndirect) { 348 DirectSize = CGF.getPointerSize(); 349 DirectAlign = CGF.getPointerAlign(); 350 } else { 351 DirectSize = ValueInfo.first; 352 DirectAlign = ValueInfo.second; 353 } 354 355 // Cast the address we've calculated to the right type. 356 llvm::Type *DirectTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(ValueTy); 357 if (IsIndirect) 358 DirectTy = DirectTy->getPointerTo(0); 359 360 Address Addr = emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, DirectTy, 361 DirectSize, DirectAlign, 362 SlotSizeAndAlign, 363 AllowHigherAlign); 364 365 if (IsIndirect) { 366 Addr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(Addr), ValueInfo.second); 367 } 368 369 return Addr; 370 371 } 372 373 static Address emitMergePHI(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 374 Address Addr1, llvm::BasicBlock *Block1, 375 Address Addr2, llvm::BasicBlock *Block2, 376 const llvm::Twine &Name = "") { 377 assert(Addr1.getType() == Addr2.getType()); 378 llvm::PHINode *PHI = CGF.Builder.CreatePHI(Addr1.getType(), 2, Name); 379 PHI->addIncoming(Addr1.getPointer(), Block1); 380 PHI->addIncoming(Addr2.getPointer(), Block2); 381 CharUnits Align = std::min(Addr1.getAlignment(), Addr2.getAlignment()); 382 return Address(PHI, Align); 383 } 384 385 TargetCodeGenInfo::~TargetCodeGenInfo() { delete Info; } 386 387 // If someone can figure out a general rule for this, that would be great. 388 // It's probably just doomed to be platform-dependent, though. 389 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getSizeOfUnwindException() const { 390 // Verified for: 391 // x86-64 FreeBSD, Linux, Darwin 392 // x86-32 FreeBSD, Linux, Darwin 393 // PowerPC Linux, Darwin 394 // ARM Darwin (*not* EABI) 395 // AArch64 Linux 396 return 32; 397 } 398 399 bool TargetCodeGenInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args, 400 const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const { 401 // The following conventions are known to require this to be false: 402 // x86_stdcall 403 // MIPS 404 // For everything else, we just prefer false unless we opt out. 405 return false; 406 } 407 408 void 409 TargetCodeGenInfo::getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 410 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const { 411 // This assumes the user is passing a library name like "rt" instead of a 412 // filename like "librt.a/so", and that they don't care whether it's static or 413 // dynamic. 414 Opt = "-l"; 415 Opt += Lib; 416 } 417 418 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const { 419 // OpenCL kernels are called via an explicit runtime API with arguments 420 // set with clSetKernelArg(), not as normal sub-functions. 421 // Return SPIR_KERNEL by default as the kernel calling convention to 422 // ensure the fingerprint is fixed such way that each OpenCL argument 423 // gets one matching argument in the produced kernel function argument 424 // list to enable feasible implementation of clSetKernelArg() with 425 // aggregates etc. In case we would use the default C calling conv here, 426 // clSetKernelArg() might break depending on the target-specific 427 // conventions; different targets might split structs passed as values 428 // to multiple function arguments etc. 429 return llvm::CallingConv::SPIR_KERNEL; 430 } 431 432 llvm::Constant *TargetCodeGenInfo::getNullPointer(const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 433 llvm::PointerType *T, QualType QT) const { 434 return llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(T); 435 } 436 437 LangAS TargetCodeGenInfo::getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM, 438 const VarDecl *D) const { 439 assert(!CGM.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 440 !(CGM.getLangOpts().CUDA && CGM.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) && 441 "Address space agnostic languages only"); 442 return D ? D->getType().getAddressSpace() : LangAS::Default; 443 } 444 445 llvm::Value *TargetCodeGenInfo::performAddrSpaceCast( 446 CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, llvm::Value *Src, LangAS SrcAddr, 447 LangAS DestAddr, llvm::Type *DestTy, bool isNonNull) const { 448 // Since target may map different address spaces in AST to the same address 449 // space, an address space conversion may end up as a bitcast. 450 if (auto *C = dyn_cast<llvm::Constant>(Src)) 451 return performAddrSpaceCast(CGF.CGM, C, SrcAddr, DestAddr, DestTy); 452 return CGF.Builder.CreatePointerBitCastOrAddrSpaceCast(Src, DestTy); 453 } 454 455 llvm::Constant * 456 TargetCodeGenInfo::performAddrSpaceCast(CodeGenModule &CGM, llvm::Constant *Src, 457 LangAS SrcAddr, LangAS DestAddr, 458 llvm::Type *DestTy) const { 459 // Since target may map different address spaces in AST to the same address 460 // space, an address space conversion may end up as a bitcast. 461 return llvm::ConstantExpr::getPointerCast(Src, DestTy); 462 } 463 464 llvm::SyncScope::ID 465 TargetCodeGenInfo::getLLVMSyncScopeID(SyncScope S, llvm::LLVMContext &C) const { 466 return C.getOrInsertSyncScopeID(""); /* default sync scope */ 467 } 468 469 static bool isEmptyRecord(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, bool AllowArrays); 470 471 /// isEmptyField - Return true iff a the field is "empty", that is it 472 /// is an unnamed bit-field or an (array of) empty record(s). 473 static bool isEmptyField(ASTContext &Context, const FieldDecl *FD, 474 bool AllowArrays) { 475 if (FD->isUnnamedBitfield()) 476 return true; 477 478 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 479 480 // Constant arrays of empty records count as empty, strip them off. 481 // Constant arrays of zero length always count as empty. 482 if (AllowArrays) 483 while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) { 484 if (AT->getSize() == 0) 485 return true; 486 FT = AT->getElementType(); 487 } 488 489 const RecordType *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>(); 490 if (!RT) 491 return false; 492 493 // C++ record fields are never empty, at least in the Itanium ABI. 494 // 495 // FIXME: We should use a predicate for whether this behavior is true in the 496 // current ABI. 497 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl())) 498 return false; 499 500 return isEmptyRecord(Context, FT, AllowArrays); 501 } 502 503 /// isEmptyRecord - Return true iff a structure contains only empty 504 /// fields. Note that a structure with a flexible array member is not 505 /// considered empty. 506 static bool isEmptyRecord(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, bool AllowArrays) { 507 const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 508 if (!RT) 509 return false; 510 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 511 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 512 return false; 513 514 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 515 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 516 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) 517 if (!isEmptyRecord(Context, I.getType(), true)) 518 return false; 519 520 for (const auto *I : RD->fields()) 521 if (!isEmptyField(Context, I, AllowArrays)) 522 return false; 523 return true; 524 } 525 526 /// isSingleElementStruct - Determine if a structure is a "single 527 /// element struct", i.e. it has exactly one non-empty field or 528 /// exactly one field which is itself a single element 529 /// struct. Structures with flexible array members are never 530 /// considered single element structs. 531 /// 532 /// \return The field declaration for the single non-empty field, if 533 /// it exists. 534 static const Type *isSingleElementStruct(QualType T, ASTContext &Context) { 535 const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 536 if (!RT) 537 return nullptr; 538 539 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 540 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 541 return nullptr; 542 543 const Type *Found = nullptr; 544 545 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 546 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 547 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 548 // Ignore empty records. 549 if (isEmptyRecord(Context, I.getType(), true)) 550 continue; 551 552 // If we already found an element then this isn't a single-element struct. 553 if (Found) 554 return nullptr; 555 556 // If this is non-empty and not a single element struct, the composite 557 // cannot be a single element struct. 558 Found = isSingleElementStruct(I.getType(), Context); 559 if (!Found) 560 return nullptr; 561 } 562 } 563 564 // Check for single element. 565 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 566 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 567 568 // Ignore empty fields. 569 if (isEmptyField(Context, FD, true)) 570 continue; 571 572 // If we already found an element then this isn't a single-element 573 // struct. 574 if (Found) 575 return nullptr; 576 577 // Treat single element arrays as the element. 578 while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) { 579 if (AT->getSize().getZExtValue() != 1) 580 break; 581 FT = AT->getElementType(); 582 } 583 584 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(FT)) { 585 Found = FT.getTypePtr(); 586 } else { 587 Found = isSingleElementStruct(FT, Context); 588 if (!Found) 589 return nullptr; 590 } 591 } 592 593 // We don't consider a struct a single-element struct if it has 594 // padding beyond the element type. 595 if (Found && Context.getTypeSize(Found) != Context.getTypeSize(T)) 596 return nullptr; 597 598 return Found; 599 } 600 601 namespace { 602 Address EmitVAArgInstr(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 603 const ABIArgInfo &AI) { 604 // This default implementation defers to the llvm backend's va_arg 605 // instruction. It can handle only passing arguments directly 606 // (typically only handled in the backend for primitive types), or 607 // aggregates passed indirectly by pointer (NOTE: if the "byval" 608 // flag has ABI impact in the callee, this implementation cannot 609 // work.) 610 611 // Only a few cases are covered here at the moment -- those needed 612 // by the default abi. 613 llvm::Value *Val; 614 615 if (AI.isIndirect()) { 616 assert(!AI.getPaddingType() && 617 "Unexpected PaddingType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 618 assert( 619 !AI.getIndirectRealign() && 620 "Unexpected IndirectRealign seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 621 622 auto TyInfo = CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 623 CharUnits TyAlignForABI = TyInfo.second; 624 625 llvm::Type *BaseTy = 626 llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty)); 627 llvm::Value *Addr = 628 CGF.Builder.CreateVAArg(VAListAddr.getPointer(), BaseTy); 629 return Address(Addr, TyAlignForABI); 630 } else { 631 assert((AI.isDirect() || AI.isExtend()) && 632 "Unexpected ArgInfo Kind in generic VAArg emitter!"); 633 634 assert(!AI.getInReg() && 635 "Unexpected InReg seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 636 assert(!AI.getPaddingType() && 637 "Unexpected PaddingType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 638 assert(!AI.getDirectOffset() && 639 "Unexpected DirectOffset seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 640 assert(!AI.getCoerceToType() && 641 "Unexpected CoerceToType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 642 643 Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty, "varet"); 644 Val = CGF.Builder.CreateVAArg(VAListAddr.getPointer(), CGF.ConvertType(Ty)); 645 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(Val, Temp); 646 return Temp; 647 } 648 } 649 650 /// DefaultABIInfo - The default implementation for ABI specific 651 /// details. This implementation provides information which results in 652 /// self-consistent and sensible LLVM IR generation, but does not 653 /// conform to any particular ABI. 654 class DefaultABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 655 public: 656 DefaultABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 657 658 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 659 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 660 661 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 662 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 663 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 664 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 665 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 666 } 667 668 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 669 QualType Ty) const override { 670 return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, classifyArgumentType(Ty)); 671 } 672 }; 673 674 class DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 675 public: 676 DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 677 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {} 678 }; 679 680 ABIArgInfo DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 681 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 682 683 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 684 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 685 // passed by value. 686 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 687 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 688 689 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty); 690 } 691 692 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 693 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 694 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 695 696 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty) 697 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 698 } 699 700 ABIArgInfo DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 701 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 702 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 703 704 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) 705 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 706 707 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 708 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 709 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 710 711 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy) 712 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 713 } 714 715 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 716 // WebAssembly ABI Implementation 717 // 718 // This is a very simple ABI that relies a lot on DefaultABIInfo. 719 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 720 721 class WebAssemblyABIInfo final : public SwiftABIInfo { 722 DefaultABIInfo defaultInfo; 723 724 public: 725 explicit WebAssemblyABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 726 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), defaultInfo(CGT) {} 727 728 private: 729 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 730 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 731 732 // DefaultABIInfo's classifyReturnType and classifyArgumentType are 733 // non-virtual, but computeInfo and EmitVAArg are virtual, so we 734 // overload them. 735 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 736 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 737 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 738 for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments()) 739 Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type); 740 } 741 742 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 743 QualType Ty) const override; 744 745 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 746 bool asReturnValue) const override { 747 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 748 } 749 750 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 751 return false; 752 } 753 }; 754 755 class WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo final : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 756 public: 757 explicit WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 758 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new WebAssemblyABIInfo(CGT)) {} 759 760 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 761 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 762 TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 763 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 764 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>()) { 765 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 766 llvm::AttrBuilder B; 767 B.addAttribute("wasm-import-module", Attr->getImportModule()); 768 Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B); 769 } 770 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>()) { 771 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 772 llvm::AttrBuilder B; 773 B.addAttribute("wasm-import-name", Attr->getImportName()); 774 Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B); 775 } 776 } 777 778 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 779 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 780 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && !FD->hasPrototype()) 781 Fn->addFnAttr("no-prototype"); 782 } 783 } 784 }; 785 786 /// Classify argument of given type \p Ty. 787 ABIArgInfo WebAssemblyABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 788 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 789 790 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 791 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 792 // passed by value. 793 if (auto RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 794 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 795 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 796 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 797 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 798 // Lower single-element structs to just pass a regular value. TODO: We 799 // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using getExpand(), 800 // though watch out for things like bitfields. 801 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext())) 802 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 803 } 804 805 // Otherwise just do the default thing. 806 return defaultInfo.classifyArgumentType(Ty); 807 } 808 809 ABIArgInfo WebAssemblyABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 810 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 811 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 812 // returned by value. 813 if (!getRecordArgABI(RetTy, getCXXABI())) { 814 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 815 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 816 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 817 // Lower single-element structs to just return a regular value. TODO: We 818 // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using 819 // ABIArgInfo::getDirect(). 820 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext())) 821 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 822 } 823 } 824 825 // Otherwise just do the default thing. 826 return defaultInfo.classifyReturnType(RetTy); 827 } 828 829 Address WebAssemblyABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 830 QualType Ty) const { 831 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect=*/ false, 832 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 833 CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 834 /*AllowHigherAlign=*/ true); 835 } 836 837 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 838 // le32/PNaCl bitcode ABI Implementation 839 // 840 // This is a simplified version of the x86_32 ABI. Arguments and return values 841 // are always passed on the stack. 842 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 843 844 class PNaClABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 845 public: 846 PNaClABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 847 848 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 849 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 850 851 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 852 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 853 Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) const override; 854 }; 855 856 class PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 857 public: 858 PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 859 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PNaClABIInfo(CGT)) {} 860 }; 861 862 void PNaClABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 863 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 864 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 865 866 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 867 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 868 } 869 870 Address PNaClABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 871 QualType Ty) const { 872 // The PNaCL ABI is a bit odd, in that varargs don't use normal 873 // function classification. Structs get passed directly for varargs 874 // functions, through a rewriting transform in 875 // pnacl-llvm/lib/Transforms/NaCl/ExpandVarArgs.cpp, which allows 876 // this target to actually support a va_arg instructions with an 877 // aggregate type, unlike other targets. 878 return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 879 } 880 881 /// Classify argument of given type \p Ty. 882 ABIArgInfo PNaClABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 883 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 884 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 885 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 886 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty); 887 } else if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) { 888 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 889 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 890 } else if (Ty->isFloatingType()) { 891 // Floating-point types don't go inreg. 892 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 893 } 894 895 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty) 896 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 897 } 898 899 ABIArgInfo PNaClABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 900 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 901 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 902 903 // In the PNaCl ABI we always return records/structures on the stack. 904 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) 905 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 906 907 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 908 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 909 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 910 911 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy) 912 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 913 } 914 915 /// IsX86_MMXType - Return true if this is an MMX type. 916 bool IsX86_MMXType(llvm::Type *IRType) { 917 // Return true if the type is an MMX type <2 x i32>, <4 x i16>, or <8 x i8>. 918 return IRType->isVectorTy() && IRType->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() == 64 && 919 cast<llvm::VectorType>(IRType)->getElementType()->isIntegerTy() && 920 IRType->getScalarSizeInBits() != 64; 921 } 922 923 static llvm::Type* X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 924 StringRef Constraint, 925 llvm::Type* Ty) { 926 bool IsMMXCons = llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(Constraint) 927 .Cases("y", "&y", "^Ym", true) 928 .Default(false); 929 if (IsMMXCons && Ty->isVectorTy()) { 930 if (cast<llvm::VectorType>(Ty)->getBitWidth() != 64) { 931 // Invalid MMX constraint 932 return nullptr; 933 } 934 935 return llvm::Type::getX86_MMXTy(CGF.getLLVMContext()); 936 } 937 938 // No operation needed 939 return Ty; 940 } 941 942 /// Returns true if this type can be passed in SSE registers with the 943 /// X86_VectorCall calling convention. Shared between x86_32 and x86_64. 944 static bool isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) { 945 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 946 if (BT->isFloatingPoint() && BT->getKind() != BuiltinType::Half) { 947 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) { 948 if (&Context.getTargetInfo().getLongDoubleFormat() == 949 &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended()) 950 return false; 951 } 952 return true; 953 } 954 } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 955 // vectorcall can pass XMM, YMM, and ZMM vectors. We don't pass SSE1 MMX 956 // registers specially. 957 unsigned VecSize = Context.getTypeSize(VT); 958 if (VecSize == 128 || VecSize == 256 || VecSize == 512) 959 return true; 960 } 961 return false; 962 } 963 964 /// Returns true if this aggregate is small enough to be passed in SSE registers 965 /// in the X86_VectorCall calling convention. Shared between x86_32 and x86_64. 966 static bool isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(uint64_t NumMembers) { 967 return NumMembers <= 4; 968 } 969 970 /// Returns a Homogeneous Vector Aggregate ABIArgInfo, used in X86. 971 static ABIArgInfo getDirectX86Hva(llvm::Type* T = nullptr) { 972 auto AI = ABIArgInfo::getDirect(T); 973 AI.setInReg(true); 974 AI.setCanBeFlattened(false); 975 return AI; 976 } 977 978 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 979 // X86-32 ABI Implementation 980 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 981 982 /// Similar to llvm::CCState, but for Clang. 983 struct CCState { 984 CCState(unsigned CC) : CC(CC), FreeRegs(0), FreeSSERegs(0) {} 985 986 unsigned CC; 987 unsigned FreeRegs; 988 unsigned FreeSSERegs; 989 }; 990 991 enum { 992 // Vectorcall only allows the first 6 parameters to be passed in registers. 993 VectorcallMaxParamNumAsReg = 6 994 }; 995 996 /// X86_32ABIInfo - The X86-32 ABI information. 997 class X86_32ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 998 enum Class { 999 Integer, 1000 Float 1001 }; 1002 1003 static const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4; 1004 1005 bool IsDarwinVectorABI; 1006 bool IsRetSmallStructInRegABI; 1007 bool IsWin32StructABI; 1008 bool IsSoftFloatABI; 1009 bool IsMCUABI; 1010 unsigned DefaultNumRegisterParameters; 1011 1012 static bool isRegisterSize(unsigned Size) { 1013 return (Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32 || Size == 64); 1014 } 1015 1016 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override { 1017 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 1018 return isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(getContext(), Ty); 1019 } 1020 1021 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 1022 uint64_t NumMembers) const override { 1023 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 1024 return isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(NumMembers); 1025 } 1026 1027 bool shouldReturnTypeInRegister(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context) const; 1028 1029 /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result 1030 /// such that the argument will be passed in memory. 1031 ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, CCState &State) const; 1032 1033 ABIArgInfo getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 1034 1035 /// Return the alignment to use for the given type on the stack. 1036 unsigned getTypeStackAlignInBytes(QualType Ty, unsigned Align) const; 1037 1038 Class classify(QualType Ty) const; 1039 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const; 1040 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const; 1041 1042 /// Updates the number of available free registers, returns 1043 /// true if any registers were allocated. 1044 bool updateFreeRegs(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 1045 1046 bool shouldAggregateUseDirect(QualType Ty, CCState &State, bool &InReg, 1047 bool &NeedsPadding) const; 1048 bool shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 1049 1050 bool canExpandIndirectArgument(QualType Ty) const; 1051 1052 /// Rewrite the function info so that all memory arguments use 1053 /// inalloca. 1054 void rewriteWithInAlloca(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const; 1055 1056 void addFieldToArgStruct(SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> &FrameFields, 1057 CharUnits &StackOffset, ABIArgInfo &Info, 1058 QualType Type) const; 1059 void computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, CCState &State, 1060 bool &UsedInAlloca) const; 1061 1062 public: 1063 1064 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 1065 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 1066 QualType Ty) const override; 1067 1068 X86_32ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool DarwinVectorABI, 1069 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI, 1070 unsigned NumRegisterParameters, bool SoftFloatABI) 1071 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), IsDarwinVectorABI(DarwinVectorABI), 1072 IsRetSmallStructInRegABI(RetSmallStructInRegABI), 1073 IsWin32StructABI(Win32StructABI), 1074 IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI), 1075 IsMCUABI(CGT.getTarget().getTriple().isOSIAMCU()), 1076 DefaultNumRegisterParameters(NumRegisterParameters) {} 1077 1078 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 1079 bool asReturnValue) const override { 1080 // LLVM's x86-32 lowering currently only assigns up to three 1081 // integer registers and three fp registers. Oddly, it'll use up to 1082 // four vector registers for vectors, but those can overlap with the 1083 // scalar registers. 1084 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 3); 1085 } 1086 1087 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 1088 // x86-32 lowering does not support passing swifterror in a register. 1089 return false; 1090 } 1091 }; 1092 1093 class X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 1094 public: 1095 X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool DarwinVectorABI, 1096 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI, 1097 unsigned NumRegisterParameters, bool SoftFloatABI) 1098 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new X86_32ABIInfo( 1099 CGT, DarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, Win32StructABI, 1100 NumRegisterParameters, SoftFloatABI)) {} 1101 1102 static bool isStructReturnInRegABI( 1103 const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts); 1104 1105 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 1106 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 1107 1108 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 1109 // Darwin uses different dwarf register numbers for EH. 1110 if (CGM.getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) return 5; 1111 return 4; 1112 } 1113 1114 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 1115 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 1116 1117 llvm::Type* adjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 1118 StringRef Constraint, 1119 llvm::Type* Ty) const override { 1120 return X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CGF, Constraint, Ty); 1121 } 1122 1123 void addReturnRegisterOutputs(CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue ReturnValue, 1124 std::string &Constraints, 1125 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultRegTypes, 1126 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultTruncRegTypes, 1127 std::vector<LValue> &ResultRegDests, 1128 std::string &AsmString, 1129 unsigned NumOutputs) const override; 1130 1131 llvm::Constant * 1132 getUBSanFunctionSignature(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 1133 unsigned Sig = (0xeb << 0) | // jmp rel8 1134 (0x06 << 8) | // .+0x08 1135 ('v' << 16) | 1136 ('2' << 24); 1137 return llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGM.Int32Ty, Sig); 1138 } 1139 1140 StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override { 1141 return "movl\t%ebp, %ebp" 1142 "\t\t// marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue"; 1143 } 1144 }; 1145 1146 } 1147 1148 /// Rewrite input constraint references after adding some output constraints. 1149 /// In the case where there is one output and one input and we add one output, 1150 /// we need to replace all operand references greater than or equal to 1: 1151 /// mov $0, $1 1152 /// mov eax, $1 1153 /// The result will be: 1154 /// mov $0, $2 1155 /// mov eax, $2 1156 static void rewriteInputConstraintReferences(unsigned FirstIn, 1157 unsigned NumNewOuts, 1158 std::string &AsmString) { 1159 std::string Buf; 1160 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(Buf); 1161 size_t Pos = 0; 1162 while (Pos < AsmString.size()) { 1163 size_t DollarStart = AsmString.find('$', Pos); 1164 if (DollarStart == std::string::npos) 1165 DollarStart = AsmString.size(); 1166 size_t DollarEnd = AsmString.find_first_not_of('$', DollarStart); 1167 if (DollarEnd == std::string::npos) 1168 DollarEnd = AsmString.size(); 1169 OS << StringRef(&AsmString[Pos], DollarEnd - Pos); 1170 Pos = DollarEnd; 1171 size_t NumDollars = DollarEnd - DollarStart; 1172 if (NumDollars % 2 != 0 && Pos < AsmString.size()) { 1173 // We have an operand reference. 1174 size_t DigitStart = Pos; 1175 size_t DigitEnd = AsmString.find_first_not_of("0123456789", DigitStart); 1176 if (DigitEnd == std::string::npos) 1177 DigitEnd = AsmString.size(); 1178 StringRef OperandStr(&AsmString[DigitStart], DigitEnd - DigitStart); 1179 unsigned OperandIndex; 1180 if (!OperandStr.getAsInteger(10, OperandIndex)) { 1181 if (OperandIndex >= FirstIn) 1182 OperandIndex += NumNewOuts; 1183 OS << OperandIndex; 1184 } else { 1185 OS << OperandStr; 1186 } 1187 Pos = DigitEnd; 1188 } 1189 } 1190 AsmString = std::move(OS.str()); 1191 } 1192 1193 /// Add output constraints for EAX:EDX because they are return registers. 1194 void X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::addReturnRegisterOutputs( 1195 CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue ReturnSlot, std::string &Constraints, 1196 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultRegTypes, 1197 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultTruncRegTypes, 1198 std::vector<LValue> &ResultRegDests, std::string &AsmString, 1199 unsigned NumOutputs) const { 1200 uint64_t RetWidth = CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(ReturnSlot.getType()); 1201 1202 // Use the EAX constraint if the width is 32 or smaller and EAX:EDX if it is 1203 // larger. 1204 if (!Constraints.empty()) 1205 Constraints += ','; 1206 if (RetWidth <= 32) { 1207 Constraints += "={eax}"; 1208 ResultRegTypes.push_back(CGF.Int32Ty); 1209 } else { 1210 // Use the 'A' constraint for EAX:EDX. 1211 Constraints += "=A"; 1212 ResultRegTypes.push_back(CGF.Int64Ty); 1213 } 1214 1215 // Truncate EAX or EAX:EDX to an integer of the appropriate size. 1216 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(CGF.getLLVMContext(), RetWidth); 1217 ResultTruncRegTypes.push_back(CoerceTy); 1218 1219 // Coerce the integer by bitcasting the return slot pointer. 1220 ReturnSlot.setAddress(CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(ReturnSlot.getAddress(), 1221 CoerceTy->getPointerTo())); 1222 ResultRegDests.push_back(ReturnSlot); 1223 1224 rewriteInputConstraintReferences(NumOutputs, 1, AsmString); 1225 } 1226 1227 /// shouldReturnTypeInRegister - Determine if the given type should be 1228 /// returned in a register (for the Darwin and MCU ABI). 1229 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldReturnTypeInRegister(QualType Ty, 1230 ASTContext &Context) const { 1231 uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 1232 1233 // For i386, type must be register sized. 1234 // For the MCU ABI, it only needs to be <= 8-byte 1235 if ((IsMCUABI && Size > 64) || (!IsMCUABI && !isRegisterSize(Size))) 1236 return false; 1237 1238 if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 1239 // 64- and 128- bit vectors inside structures are not returned in 1240 // registers. 1241 if (Size == 64 || Size == 128) 1242 return false; 1243 1244 return true; 1245 } 1246 1247 // If this is a builtin, pointer, enum, complex type, member pointer, or 1248 // member function pointer it is ok. 1249 if (Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() || Ty->hasPointerRepresentation() || 1250 Ty->isAnyComplexType() || Ty->isEnumeralType() || 1251 Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) 1252 return true; 1253 1254 // Arrays are treated like records. 1255 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) 1256 return shouldReturnTypeInRegister(AT->getElementType(), Context); 1257 1258 // Otherwise, it must be a record type. 1259 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1260 if (!RT) return false; 1261 1262 // FIXME: Traverse bases here too. 1263 1264 // Structure types are passed in register if all fields would be 1265 // passed in a register. 1266 for (const auto *FD : RT->getDecl()->fields()) { 1267 // Empty fields are ignored. 1268 if (isEmptyField(Context, FD, true)) 1269 continue; 1270 1271 // Check fields recursively. 1272 if (!shouldReturnTypeInRegister(FD->getType(), Context)) 1273 return false; 1274 } 1275 return true; 1276 } 1277 1278 static bool is32Or64BitBasicType(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context) { 1279 // Treat complex types as the element type. 1280 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) 1281 Ty = CTy->getElementType(); 1282 1283 // Check for a type which we know has a simple scalar argument-passing 1284 // convention without any padding. (We're specifically looking for 32 1285 // and 64-bit integer and integer-equivalents, float, and double.) 1286 if (!Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() && !Ty->hasPointerRepresentation() && 1287 !Ty->isEnumeralType() && !Ty->isBlockPointerType()) 1288 return false; 1289 1290 uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 1291 return Size == 32 || Size == 64; 1292 } 1293 1294 static bool addFieldSizes(ASTContext &Context, const RecordDecl *RD, 1295 uint64_t &Size) { 1296 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 1297 // Scalar arguments on the stack get 4 byte alignment on x86. If the 1298 // argument is smaller than 32-bits, expanding the struct will create 1299 // alignment padding. 1300 if (!is32Or64BitBasicType(FD->getType(), Context)) 1301 return false; 1302 1303 // FIXME: Reject bit-fields wholesale; there are two problems, we don't know 1304 // how to expand them yet, and the predicate for telling if a bitfield still 1305 // counts as "basic" is more complicated than what we were doing previously. 1306 if (FD->isBitField()) 1307 return false; 1308 1309 Size += Context.getTypeSize(FD->getType()); 1310 } 1311 return true; 1312 } 1313 1314 static bool addBaseAndFieldSizes(ASTContext &Context, const CXXRecordDecl *RD, 1315 uint64_t &Size) { 1316 // Don't do this if there are any non-empty bases. 1317 for (const CXXBaseSpecifier &Base : RD->bases()) { 1318 if (!addBaseAndFieldSizes(Context, Base.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(), 1319 Size)) 1320 return false; 1321 } 1322 if (!addFieldSizes(Context, RD, Size)) 1323 return false; 1324 return true; 1325 } 1326 1327 /// Test whether an argument type which is to be passed indirectly (on the 1328 /// stack) would have the equivalent layout if it was expanded into separate 1329 /// arguments. If so, we prefer to do the latter to avoid inhibiting 1330 /// optimizations. 1331 bool X86_32ABIInfo::canExpandIndirectArgument(QualType Ty) const { 1332 // We can only expand structure types. 1333 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1334 if (!RT) 1335 return false; 1336 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 1337 uint64_t Size = 0; 1338 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 1339 if (!IsWin32StructABI) { 1340 // On non-Windows, we have to conservatively match our old bitcode 1341 // prototypes in order to be ABI-compatible at the bitcode level. 1342 if (!CXXRD->isCLike()) 1343 return false; 1344 } else { 1345 // Don't do this for dynamic classes. 1346 if (CXXRD->isDynamicClass()) 1347 return false; 1348 } 1349 if (!addBaseAndFieldSizes(getContext(), CXXRD, Size)) 1350 return false; 1351 } else { 1352 if (!addFieldSizes(getContext(), RD, Size)) 1353 return false; 1354 } 1355 1356 // We can do this if there was no alignment padding. 1357 return Size == getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 1358 } 1359 1360 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::getIndirectReturnResult(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const { 1361 // If the return value is indirect, then the hidden argument is consuming one 1362 // integer register. 1363 if (State.FreeRegs) { 1364 --State.FreeRegs; 1365 if (!IsMCUABI) 1366 return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(RetTy); 1367 } 1368 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/false); 1369 } 1370 1371 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, 1372 CCState &State) const { 1373 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 1374 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 1375 1376 const Type *Base = nullptr; 1377 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 1378 if ((State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall || 1379 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) && 1380 isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, NumElts)) { 1381 // The LLVM struct type for such an aggregate should lower properly. 1382 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1383 } 1384 1385 if (const VectorType *VT = RetTy->getAs<VectorType>()) { 1386 // On Darwin, some vectors are returned in registers. 1387 if (IsDarwinVectorABI) { 1388 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 1389 1390 // 128-bit vectors are a special case; they are returned in 1391 // registers and we need to make sure to pick a type the LLVM 1392 // backend will like. 1393 if (Size == 128) 1394 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::VectorType::get( 1395 llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()), 2)); 1396 1397 // Always return in register if it fits in a general purpose 1398 // register, or if it is 64 bits and has a single element. 1399 if ((Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) || 1400 (Size == 64 && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) 1401 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 1402 Size)); 1403 1404 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1405 } 1406 1407 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1408 } 1409 1410 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 1411 if (const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 1412 // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect. 1413 if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 1414 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1415 } 1416 1417 // If specified, structs and unions are always indirect. 1418 if (!IsRetSmallStructInRegABI && !RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 1419 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1420 1421 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 1422 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 1423 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 1424 1425 // Small structures which are register sized are generally returned 1426 // in a register. 1427 if (shouldReturnTypeInRegister(RetTy, getContext())) { 1428 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 1429 1430 // As a special-case, if the struct is a "single-element" struct, and 1431 // the field is of type "float" or "double", return it in a 1432 // floating-point register. (MSVC does not apply this special case.) 1433 // We apply a similar transformation for pointer types to improve the 1434 // quality of the generated IR. 1435 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext())) 1436 if ((!IsWin32StructABI && SeltTy->isRealFloatingType()) 1437 || SeltTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) 1438 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 1439 1440 // FIXME: We should be able to narrow this integer in cases with dead 1441 // padding. 1442 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),Size)); 1443 } 1444 1445 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1446 } 1447 1448 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 1449 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 1450 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 1451 1452 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy) 1453 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 1454 } 1455 1456 static bool isSSEVectorType(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) { 1457 return Ty->getAs<VectorType>() && Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == 128; 1458 } 1459 1460 static bool isRecordWithSSEVectorType(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) { 1461 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1462 if (!RT) 1463 return 0; 1464 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 1465 1466 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 1467 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 1468 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) 1469 if (!isRecordWithSSEVectorType(Context, I.getType())) 1470 return false; 1471 1472 for (const auto *i : RD->fields()) { 1473 QualType FT = i->getType(); 1474 1475 if (isSSEVectorType(Context, FT)) 1476 return true; 1477 1478 if (isRecordWithSSEVectorType(Context, FT)) 1479 return true; 1480 } 1481 1482 return false; 1483 } 1484 1485 unsigned X86_32ABIInfo::getTypeStackAlignInBytes(QualType Ty, 1486 unsigned Align) const { 1487 // Otherwise, if the alignment is less than or equal to the minimum ABI 1488 // alignment, just use the default; the backend will handle this. 1489 if (Align <= MinABIStackAlignInBytes) 1490 return 0; // Use default alignment. 1491 1492 // On non-Darwin, the stack type alignment is always 4. 1493 if (!IsDarwinVectorABI) { 1494 // Set explicit alignment, since we may need to realign the top. 1495 return MinABIStackAlignInBytes; 1496 } 1497 1498 // Otherwise, if the type contains an SSE vector type, the alignment is 16. 1499 if (Align >= 16 && (isSSEVectorType(getContext(), Ty) || 1500 isRecordWithSSEVectorType(getContext(), Ty))) 1501 return 16; 1502 1503 return MinABIStackAlignInBytes; 1504 } 1505 1506 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, 1507 CCState &State) const { 1508 if (!ByVal) { 1509 if (State.FreeRegs) { 1510 --State.FreeRegs; // Non-byval indirects just use one pointer. 1511 if (!IsMCUABI) 1512 return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty); 1513 } 1514 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false); 1515 } 1516 1517 // Compute the byval alignment. 1518 unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 1519 unsigned StackAlign = getTypeStackAlignInBytes(Ty, TypeAlign); 1520 if (StackAlign == 0) 1521 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true); 1522 1523 // If the stack alignment is less than the type alignment, realign the 1524 // argument. 1525 bool Realign = TypeAlign > StackAlign; 1526 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(StackAlign), 1527 /*ByVal=*/true, Realign); 1528 } 1529 1530 X86_32ABIInfo::Class X86_32ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty) const { 1531 const Type *T = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()); 1532 if (!T) 1533 T = Ty.getTypePtr(); 1534 1535 if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 1536 BuiltinType::Kind K = BT->getKind(); 1537 if (K == BuiltinType::Float || K == BuiltinType::Double) 1538 return Float; 1539 } 1540 return Integer; 1541 } 1542 1543 bool X86_32ABIInfo::updateFreeRegs(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const { 1544 if (!IsSoftFloatABI) { 1545 Class C = classify(Ty); 1546 if (C == Float) 1547 return false; 1548 } 1549 1550 unsigned Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 1551 unsigned SizeInRegs = (Size + 31) / 32; 1552 1553 if (SizeInRegs == 0) 1554 return false; 1555 1556 if (!IsMCUABI) { 1557 if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs) { 1558 State.FreeRegs = 0; 1559 return false; 1560 } 1561 } else { 1562 // The MCU psABI allows passing parameters in-reg even if there are 1563 // earlier parameters that are passed on the stack. Also, 1564 // it does not allow passing >8-byte structs in-register, 1565 // even if there are 3 free registers available. 1566 if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs || SizeInRegs > 2) 1567 return false; 1568 } 1569 1570 State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs; 1571 return true; 1572 } 1573 1574 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldAggregateUseDirect(QualType Ty, CCState &State, 1575 bool &InReg, 1576 bool &NeedsPadding) const { 1577 // On Windows, aggregates other than HFAs are never passed in registers, and 1578 // they do not consume register slots. Homogenous floating-point aggregates 1579 // (HFAs) have already been dealt with at this point. 1580 if (IsWin32StructABI && isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) 1581 return false; 1582 1583 NeedsPadding = false; 1584 InReg = !IsMCUABI; 1585 1586 if (!updateFreeRegs(Ty, State)) 1587 return false; 1588 1589 if (IsMCUABI) 1590 return true; 1591 1592 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall || 1593 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall || 1594 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) { 1595 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 32 && State.FreeRegs) 1596 NeedsPadding = true; 1597 1598 return false; 1599 } 1600 1601 return true; 1602 } 1603 1604 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const { 1605 if (!updateFreeRegs(Ty, State)) 1606 return false; 1607 1608 if (IsMCUABI) 1609 return false; 1610 1611 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall || 1612 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall || 1613 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) { 1614 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) > 32) 1615 return false; 1616 1617 return (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || Ty->isPointerType() || 1618 Ty->isReferenceType()); 1619 } 1620 1621 return true; 1622 } 1623 1624 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 1625 CCState &State) const { 1626 // FIXME: Set alignment on indirect arguments. 1627 1628 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 1629 1630 // Check with the C++ ABI first. 1631 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1632 if (RT) { 1633 CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()); 1634 if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) { 1635 return getIndirectResult(Ty, false, State); 1636 } else if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) { 1637 // The field index doesn't matter, we'll fix it up later. 1638 return ABIArgInfo::getInAlloca(/*FieldIndex=*/0); 1639 } 1640 } 1641 1642 // Regcall uses the concept of a homogenous vector aggregate, similar 1643 // to other targets. 1644 const Type *Base = nullptr; 1645 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 1646 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall && 1647 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) { 1648 1649 if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 1650 State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 1651 if (Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType()) 1652 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1653 return ABIArgInfo::getExpand(); 1654 } 1655 return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State); 1656 } 1657 1658 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 1659 // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect. 1660 // FIXME: This should not be byval! 1661 if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 1662 return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State); 1663 1664 // Ignore empty structs/unions on non-Windows. 1665 if (!IsWin32StructABI && isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 1666 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 1667 1668 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext(); 1669 llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext); 1670 bool NeedsPadding = false; 1671 bool InReg; 1672 if (shouldAggregateUseDirect(Ty, State, InReg, NeedsPadding)) { 1673 unsigned SizeInRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 1674 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32); 1675 llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements); 1676 if (InReg) 1677 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result); 1678 else 1679 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Result); 1680 } 1681 llvm::IntegerType *PaddingType = NeedsPadding ? Int32 : nullptr; 1682 1683 // Expand small (<= 128-bit) record types when we know that the stack layout 1684 // of those arguments will match the struct. This is important because the 1685 // LLVM backend isn't smart enough to remove byval, which inhibits many 1686 // optimizations. 1687 // Don't do this for the MCU if there are still free integer registers 1688 // (see X86_64 ABI for full explanation). 1689 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 4 * 32 && 1690 (!IsMCUABI || State.FreeRegs == 0) && canExpandIndirectArgument(Ty)) 1691 return ABIArgInfo::getExpandWithPadding( 1692 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall || 1693 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall || 1694 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall, 1695 PaddingType); 1696 1697 return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State); 1698 } 1699 1700 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 1701 // On Darwin, some vectors are passed in memory, we handle this by passing 1702 // it as an i8/i16/i32/i64. 1703 if (IsDarwinVectorABI) { 1704 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 1705 if ((Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) || 1706 (Size == 64 && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) 1707 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 1708 Size)); 1709 } 1710 1711 if (IsX86_MMXType(CGT.ConvertType(Ty))) 1712 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 64)); 1713 1714 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1715 } 1716 1717 1718 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 1719 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 1720 1721 bool InReg = shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(Ty, State); 1722 1723 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 1724 if (InReg) 1725 return ABIArgInfo::getExtendInReg(Ty); 1726 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty); 1727 } 1728 1729 if (InReg) 1730 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(); 1731 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1732 } 1733 1734 void X86_32ABIInfo::computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, CCState &State, 1735 bool &UsedInAlloca) const { 1736 // Vectorcall x86 works subtly different than in x64, so the format is 1737 // a bit different than the x64 version. First, all vector types (not HVAs) 1738 // are assigned, with the first 6 ending up in the YMM0-5 or XMM0-5 registers. 1739 // This differs from the x64 implementation, where the first 6 by INDEX get 1740 // registers. 1741 // After that, integers AND HVAs are assigned Left to Right in the same pass. 1742 // Integers are passed as ECX/EDX if one is available (in order). HVAs will 1743 // first take up the remaining YMM/XMM registers. If insufficient registers 1744 // remain but an integer register (ECX/EDX) is available, it will be passed 1745 // in that, else, on the stack. 1746 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 1747 // First pass do all the vector types. 1748 const Type *Base = nullptr; 1749 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 1750 const QualType& Ty = I.type; 1751 if ((Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isBuiltinType()) && 1752 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) { 1753 if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 1754 State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 1755 I.info = ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1756 } else { 1757 I.info = classifyArgumentType(Ty, State); 1758 } 1759 UsedInAlloca |= (I.info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca); 1760 } 1761 } 1762 1763 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 1764 // Second pass, do the rest! 1765 const Type *Base = nullptr; 1766 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 1767 const QualType& Ty = I.type; 1768 bool IsHva = isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts); 1769 1770 if (IsHva && !Ty->isVectorType() && !Ty->isBuiltinType()) { 1771 // Assign true HVAs (non vector/native FP types). 1772 if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 1773 State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 1774 I.info = getDirectX86Hva(); 1775 } else { 1776 I.info = getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State); 1777 } 1778 } else if (!IsHva) { 1779 // Assign all Non-HVAs, so this will exclude Vector/FP args. 1780 I.info = classifyArgumentType(Ty, State); 1781 UsedInAlloca |= (I.info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca); 1782 } 1783 } 1784 } 1785 1786 void X86_32ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 1787 CCState State(FI.getCallingConvention()); 1788 if (IsMCUABI) 1789 State.FreeRegs = 3; 1790 else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall) 1791 State.FreeRegs = 2; 1792 else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall) { 1793 State.FreeRegs = 2; 1794 State.FreeSSERegs = 6; 1795 } else if (FI.getHasRegParm()) 1796 State.FreeRegs = FI.getRegParm(); 1797 else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) { 1798 State.FreeRegs = 5; 1799 State.FreeSSERegs = 8; 1800 } else 1801 State.FreeRegs = DefaultNumRegisterParameters; 1802 1803 if (!::classifyReturnType(getCXXABI(), FI, *this)) { 1804 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), State); 1805 } else if (FI.getReturnInfo().isIndirect()) { 1806 // The C++ ABI is not aware of register usage, so we have to check if the 1807 // return value was sret and put it in a register ourselves if appropriate. 1808 if (State.FreeRegs) { 1809 --State.FreeRegs; // The sret parameter consumes a register. 1810 if (!IsMCUABI) 1811 FI.getReturnInfo().setInReg(true); 1812 } 1813 } 1814 1815 // The chain argument effectively gives us another free register. 1816 if (FI.isChainCall()) 1817 ++State.FreeRegs; 1818 1819 bool UsedInAlloca = false; 1820 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall) { 1821 computeVectorCallArgs(FI, State, UsedInAlloca); 1822 } else { 1823 // If not vectorcall, revert to normal behavior. 1824 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 1825 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State); 1826 UsedInAlloca |= (I.info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca); 1827 } 1828 } 1829 1830 // If we needed to use inalloca for any argument, do a second pass and rewrite 1831 // all the memory arguments to use inalloca. 1832 if (UsedInAlloca) 1833 rewriteWithInAlloca(FI); 1834 } 1835 1836 void 1837 X86_32ABIInfo::addFieldToArgStruct(SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> &FrameFields, 1838 CharUnits &StackOffset, ABIArgInfo &Info, 1839 QualType Type) const { 1840 // Arguments are always 4-byte-aligned. 1841 CharUnits FieldAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 1842 1843 assert(StackOffset.isMultipleOf(FieldAlign) && "unaligned inalloca struct"); 1844 Info = ABIArgInfo::getInAlloca(FrameFields.size()); 1845 FrameFields.push_back(CGT.ConvertTypeForMem(Type)); 1846 StackOffset += getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Type); 1847 1848 // Insert padding bytes to respect alignment. 1849 CharUnits FieldEnd = StackOffset; 1850 StackOffset = FieldEnd.alignTo(FieldAlign); 1851 if (StackOffset != FieldEnd) { 1852 CharUnits NumBytes = StackOffset - FieldEnd; 1853 llvm::Type *Ty = llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()); 1854 Ty = llvm::ArrayType::get(Ty, NumBytes.getQuantity()); 1855 FrameFields.push_back(Ty); 1856 } 1857 } 1858 1859 static bool isArgInAlloca(const ABIArgInfo &Info) { 1860 // Leave ignored and inreg arguments alone. 1861 switch (Info.getKind()) { 1862 case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca: 1863 return true; 1864 case ABIArgInfo::Indirect: 1865 assert(Info.getIndirectByVal()); 1866 return true; 1867 case ABIArgInfo::Ignore: 1868 return false; 1869 case ABIArgInfo::Direct: 1870 case ABIArgInfo::Extend: 1871 if (Info.getInReg()) 1872 return false; 1873 return true; 1874 case ABIArgInfo::Expand: 1875 case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand: 1876 // These are aggregate types which are never passed in registers when 1877 // inalloca is involved. 1878 return true; 1879 } 1880 llvm_unreachable("invalid enum"); 1881 } 1882 1883 void X86_32ABIInfo::rewriteWithInAlloca(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 1884 assert(IsWin32StructABI && "inalloca only supported on win32"); 1885 1886 // Build a packed struct type for all of the arguments in memory. 1887 SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> FrameFields; 1888 1889 // The stack alignment is always 4. 1890 CharUnits StackAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 1891 1892 CharUnits StackOffset; 1893 CGFunctionInfo::arg_iterator I = FI.arg_begin(), E = FI.arg_end(); 1894 1895 // Put 'this' into the struct before 'sret', if necessary. 1896 bool IsThisCall = 1897 FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_ThisCall; 1898 ABIArgInfo &Ret = FI.getReturnInfo(); 1899 if (Ret.isIndirect() && Ret.isSRetAfterThis() && !IsThisCall && 1900 isArgInAlloca(I->info)) { 1901 addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, I->info, I->type); 1902 ++I; 1903 } 1904 1905 // Put the sret parameter into the inalloca struct if it's in memory. 1906 if (Ret.isIndirect() && !Ret.getInReg()) { 1907 CanQualType PtrTy = getContext().getPointerType(FI.getReturnType()); 1908 addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, Ret, PtrTy); 1909 // On Windows, the hidden sret parameter is always returned in eax. 1910 Ret.setInAllocaSRet(IsWin32StructABI); 1911 } 1912 1913 // Skip the 'this' parameter in ecx. 1914 if (IsThisCall) 1915 ++I; 1916 1917 // Put arguments passed in memory into the struct. 1918 for (; I != E; ++I) { 1919 if (isArgInAlloca(I->info)) 1920 addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, I->info, I->type); 1921 } 1922 1923 FI.setArgStruct(llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), FrameFields, 1924 /*isPacked=*/true), 1925 StackAlign); 1926 } 1927 1928 Address X86_32ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 1929 Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) const { 1930 1931 auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 1932 1933 // x86-32 changes the alignment of certain arguments on the stack. 1934 // 1935 // Just messing with TypeInfo like this works because we never pass 1936 // anything indirectly. 1937 TypeInfo.second = CharUnits::fromQuantity( 1938 getTypeStackAlignInBytes(Ty, TypeInfo.second.getQuantity())); 1939 1940 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false, 1941 TypeInfo, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 1942 /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 1943 } 1944 1945 bool X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI( 1946 const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts) { 1947 assert(Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86); 1948 1949 switch (Opts.getStructReturnConvention()) { 1950 case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_Default: 1951 break; 1952 case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_OnStack: // -fpcc-struct-return 1953 return false; 1954 case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_InRegs: // -freg-struct-return 1955 return true; 1956 } 1957 1958 if (Triple.isOSDarwin() || Triple.isOSIAMCU()) 1959 return true; 1960 1961 switch (Triple.getOS()) { 1962 case llvm::Triple::DragonFly: 1963 case llvm::Triple::FreeBSD: 1964 case llvm::Triple::OpenBSD: 1965 case llvm::Triple::Win32: 1966 return true; 1967 default: 1968 return false; 1969 } 1970 } 1971 1972 void X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 1973 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 1974 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 1975 return; 1976 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1977 if (FD->hasAttr<X86ForceAlignArgPointerAttr>()) { 1978 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 1979 Fn->addFnAttr("stackrealign"); 1980 } 1981 if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 1982 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 1983 Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR); 1984 } 1985 } 1986 } 1987 1988 bool X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable( 1989 CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 1990 llvm::Value *Address) const { 1991 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 1992 1993 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4); 1994 1995 // 0-7 are the eight integer registers; the order is different 1996 // on Darwin (for EH), but the range is the same. 1997 // 8 is %eip. 1998 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 8); 1999 2000 if (CGF.CGM.getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) { 2001 // 12-16 are st(0..4). Not sure why we stop at 4. 2002 // These have size 16, which is sizeof(long double) on 2003 // platforms with 8-byte alignment for that type. 2004 llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 16); 2005 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 12, 16); 2006 2007 } else { 2008 // 9 is %eflags, which doesn't get a size on Darwin for some 2009 // reason. 2010 Builder.CreateAlignedStore( 2011 Four8, Builder.CreateConstInBoundsGEP1_32(CGF.Int8Ty, Address, 9), 2012 CharUnits::One()); 2013 2014 // 11-16 are st(0..5). Not sure why we stop at 5. 2015 // These have size 12, which is sizeof(long double) on 2016 // platforms with 4-byte alignment for that type. 2017 llvm::Value *Twelve8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 12); 2018 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Twelve8, 11, 16); 2019 } 2020 2021 return false; 2022 } 2023 2024 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 2025 // X86-64 ABI Implementation 2026 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 2027 2028 2029 namespace { 2030 /// The AVX ABI level for X86 targets. 2031 enum class X86AVXABILevel { 2032 None, 2033 AVX, 2034 AVX512 2035 }; 2036 2037 /// \p returns the size in bits of the largest (native) vector for \p AVXLevel. 2038 static unsigned getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) { 2039 switch (AVXLevel) { 2040 case X86AVXABILevel::AVX512: 2041 return 512; 2042 case X86AVXABILevel::AVX: 2043 return 256; 2044 case X86AVXABILevel::None: 2045 return 128; 2046 } 2047 llvm_unreachable("Unknown AVXLevel"); 2048 } 2049 2050 /// X86_64ABIInfo - The X86_64 ABI information. 2051 class X86_64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 2052 enum Class { 2053 Integer = 0, 2054 SSE, 2055 SSEUp, 2056 X87, 2057 X87Up, 2058 ComplexX87, 2059 NoClass, 2060 Memory 2061 }; 2062 2063 /// merge - Implement the X86_64 ABI merging algorithm. 2064 /// 2065 /// Merge an accumulating classification \arg Accum with a field 2066 /// classification \arg Field. 2067 /// 2068 /// \param Accum - The accumulating classification. This should 2069 /// always be either NoClass or the result of a previous merge 2070 /// call. In addition, this should never be Memory (the caller 2071 /// should just return Memory for the aggregate). 2072 static Class merge(Class Accum, Class Field); 2073 2074 /// postMerge - Implement the X86_64 ABI post merging algorithm. 2075 /// 2076 /// Post merger cleanup, reduces a malformed Hi and Lo pair to 2077 /// final MEMORY or SSE classes when necessary. 2078 /// 2079 /// \param AggregateSize - The size of the current aggregate in 2080 /// the classification process. 2081 /// 2082 /// \param Lo - The classification for the parts of the type 2083 /// residing in the low word of the containing object. 2084 /// 2085 /// \param Hi - The classification for the parts of the type 2086 /// residing in the higher words of the containing object. 2087 /// 2088 void postMerge(unsigned AggregateSize, Class &Lo, Class &Hi) const; 2089 2090 /// classify - Determine the x86_64 register classes in which the 2091 /// given type T should be passed. 2092 /// 2093 /// \param Lo - The classification for the parts of the type 2094 /// residing in the low word of the containing object. 2095 /// 2096 /// \param Hi - The classification for the parts of the type 2097 /// residing in the high word of the containing object. 2098 /// 2099 /// \param OffsetBase - The bit offset of this type in the 2100 /// containing object. Some parameters are classified different 2101 /// depending on whether they straddle an eightbyte boundary. 2102 /// 2103 /// \param isNamedArg - Whether the argument in question is a "named" 2104 /// argument, as used in AMD64-ABI 3.5.7. 2105 /// 2106 /// If a word is unused its result will be NoClass; if a type should 2107 /// be passed in Memory then at least the classification of \arg Lo 2108 /// will be Memory. 2109 /// 2110 /// The \arg Lo class will be NoClass iff the argument is ignored. 2111 /// 2112 /// If the \arg Lo class is ComplexX87, then the \arg Hi class will 2113 /// also be ComplexX87. 2114 void classify(QualType T, uint64_t OffsetBase, Class &Lo, Class &Hi, 2115 bool isNamedArg) const; 2116 2117 llvm::Type *GetByteVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 2118 llvm::Type *GetSSETypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, 2119 unsigned IROffset, QualType SourceTy, 2120 unsigned SourceOffset) const; 2121 llvm::Type *GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, 2122 unsigned IROffset, QualType SourceTy, 2123 unsigned SourceOffset) const; 2124 2125 /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result 2126 /// such that the argument will be returned in memory. 2127 ABIArgInfo getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty) const; 2128 2129 /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result 2130 /// such that the argument will be passed in memory. 2131 /// 2132 /// \param freeIntRegs - The number of free integer registers remaining 2133 /// available. 2134 ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs) const; 2135 2136 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 2137 2138 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs, 2139 unsigned &neededInt, unsigned &neededSSE, 2140 bool isNamedArg) const; 2141 2142 ABIArgInfo classifyRegCallStructType(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt, 2143 unsigned &NeededSSE) const; 2144 2145 ABIArgInfo classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt, 2146 unsigned &NeededSSE) const; 2147 2148 bool IsIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 2149 2150 /// The 0.98 ABI revision clarified a lot of ambiguities, 2151 /// unfortunately in ways that were not always consistent with 2152 /// certain previous compilers. In particular, platforms which 2153 /// required strict binary compatibility with older versions of GCC 2154 /// may need to exempt themselves. 2155 bool honorsRevision0_98() const { 2156 return !getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin(); 2157 } 2158 2159 /// GCC classifies <1 x long long> as SSE but some platform ABIs choose to 2160 /// classify it as INTEGER (for compatibility with older clang compilers). 2161 bool classifyIntegerMMXAsSSE() const { 2162 // Clang <= 3.8 did not do this. 2163 if (getContext().getLangOpts().getClangABICompat() <= 2164 LangOptions::ClangABI::Ver3_8) 2165 return false; 2166 2167 const llvm::Triple &Triple = getTarget().getTriple(); 2168 if (Triple.isOSDarwin() || Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::PS4) 2169 return false; 2170 if (Triple.isOSFreeBSD() && Triple.getOSMajorVersion() >= 10) 2171 return false; 2172 return true; 2173 } 2174 2175 X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel; 2176 // Some ABIs (e.g. X32 ABI and Native Client OS) use 32 bit pointers on 2177 // 64-bit hardware. 2178 bool Has64BitPointers; 2179 2180 public: 2181 X86_64ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) : 2182 SwiftABIInfo(CGT), AVXLevel(AVXLevel), 2183 Has64BitPointers(CGT.getDataLayout().getPointerSize(0) == 8) { 2184 } 2185 2186 bool isPassedUsingAVXType(QualType type) const { 2187 unsigned neededInt, neededSSE; 2188 // The freeIntRegs argument doesn't matter here. 2189 ABIArgInfo info = classifyArgumentType(type, 0, neededInt, neededSSE, 2190 /*isNamedArg*/true); 2191 if (info.isDirect()) { 2192 llvm::Type *ty = info.getCoerceToType(); 2193 if (llvm::VectorType *vectorTy = dyn_cast_or_null<llvm::VectorType>(ty)) 2194 return (vectorTy->getBitWidth() > 128); 2195 } 2196 return false; 2197 } 2198 2199 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 2200 2201 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 2202 QualType Ty) const override; 2203 Address EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 2204 QualType Ty) const override; 2205 2206 bool has64BitPointers() const { 2207 return Has64BitPointers; 2208 } 2209 2210 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 2211 bool asReturnValue) const override { 2212 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 2213 } 2214 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 2215 return true; 2216 } 2217 }; 2218 2219 /// WinX86_64ABIInfo - The Windows X86_64 ABI information. 2220 class WinX86_64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 2221 public: 2222 WinX86_64ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 2223 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), 2224 IsMingw64(getTarget().getTriple().isWindowsGNUEnvironment()) {} 2225 2226 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 2227 2228 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 2229 QualType Ty) const override; 2230 2231 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override { 2232 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 2233 return isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(getContext(), Ty); 2234 } 2235 2236 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 2237 uint64_t NumMembers) const override { 2238 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 2239 return isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(NumMembers); 2240 } 2241 2242 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type *> scalars, 2243 bool asReturnValue) const override { 2244 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 2245 } 2246 2247 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 2248 return true; 2249 } 2250 2251 private: 2252 ABIArgInfo classify(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, bool IsReturnType, 2253 bool IsVectorCall, bool IsRegCall) const; 2254 ABIArgInfo reclassifyHvaArgType(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, 2255 const ABIArgInfo ¤t) const; 2256 void computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, unsigned FreeSSERegs, 2257 bool IsVectorCall, bool IsRegCall) const; 2258 2259 bool IsMingw64; 2260 }; 2261 2262 class X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 2263 public: 2264 X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) 2265 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new X86_64ABIInfo(CGT, AVXLevel)) {} 2266 2267 const X86_64ABIInfo &getABIInfo() const { 2268 return static_cast<const X86_64ABIInfo&>(TargetCodeGenInfo::getABIInfo()); 2269 } 2270 2271 /// Disable tail call on x86-64. The epilogue code before the tail jump blocks 2272 /// the autoreleaseRV/retainRV optimization. 2273 bool shouldSuppressTailCallsOfRetainAutoreleasedReturnValue() const override { 2274 return true; 2275 } 2276 2277 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2278 return 7; 2279 } 2280 2281 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 2282 llvm::Value *Address) const override { 2283 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 8); 2284 2285 // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers. 2286 // 16 is %rip. 2287 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 16); 2288 return false; 2289 } 2290 2291 llvm::Type* adjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 2292 StringRef Constraint, 2293 llvm::Type* Ty) const override { 2294 return X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CGF, Constraint, Ty); 2295 } 2296 2297 bool isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args, 2298 const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const override { 2299 // The default CC on x86-64 sets %al to the number of SSA 2300 // registers used, and GCC sets this when calling an unprototyped 2301 // function, so we override the default behavior. However, don't do 2302 // that when AVX types are involved: the ABI explicitly states it is 2303 // undefined, and it doesn't work in practice because of how the ABI 2304 // defines varargs anyway. 2305 if (fnType->getCallConv() == CC_C) { 2306 bool HasAVXType = false; 2307 for (CallArgList::const_iterator 2308 it = args.begin(), ie = args.end(); it != ie; ++it) { 2309 if (getABIInfo().isPassedUsingAVXType(it->Ty)) { 2310 HasAVXType = true; 2311 break; 2312 } 2313 } 2314 2315 if (!HasAVXType) 2316 return true; 2317 } 2318 2319 return TargetCodeGenInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic(args, fnType); 2320 } 2321 2322 llvm::Constant * 2323 getUBSanFunctionSignature(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2324 unsigned Sig = (0xeb << 0) | // jmp rel8 2325 (0x06 << 8) | // .+0x08 2326 ('v' << 16) | 2327 ('2' << 24); 2328 return llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGM.Int32Ty, Sig); 2329 } 2330 2331 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2332 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2333 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 2334 return; 2335 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2336 if (FD->hasAttr<X86ForceAlignArgPointerAttr>()) { 2337 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 2338 Fn->addFnAttr("stackrealign"); 2339 } 2340 if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 2341 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 2342 Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR); 2343 } 2344 } 2345 } 2346 }; 2347 2348 class PS4TargetCodeGenInfo : public X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo { 2349 public: 2350 PS4TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) 2351 : X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, AVXLevel) {} 2352 2353 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 2354 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 2355 Opt = "\01"; 2356 // If the argument contains a space, enclose it in quotes. 2357 if (Lib.find(" ") != StringRef::npos) 2358 Opt += "\"" + Lib.str() + "\""; 2359 else 2360 Opt += Lib; 2361 } 2362 }; 2363 2364 static std::string qualifyWindowsLibrary(llvm::StringRef Lib) { 2365 // If the argument does not end in .lib, automatically add the suffix. 2366 // If the argument contains a space, enclose it in quotes. 2367 // This matches the behavior of MSVC. 2368 bool Quote = (Lib.find(" ") != StringRef::npos); 2369 std::string ArgStr = Quote ? "\"" : ""; 2370 ArgStr += Lib; 2371 if (!Lib.endswith_lower(".lib") && !Lib.endswith_lower(".a")) 2372 ArgStr += ".lib"; 2373 ArgStr += Quote ? "\"" : ""; 2374 return ArgStr; 2375 } 2376 2377 class WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo : public X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo { 2378 public: 2379 WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, 2380 bool DarwinVectorABI, bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI, 2381 unsigned NumRegisterParameters) 2382 : X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, DarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, 2383 Win32StructABI, NumRegisterParameters, false) {} 2384 2385 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2386 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 2387 2388 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 2389 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 2390 Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:"; 2391 Opt += qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib); 2392 } 2393 2394 void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, 2395 llvm::StringRef Value, 2396 llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override { 2397 Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\""; 2398 } 2399 }; 2400 2401 static void addStackProbeTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2402 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) { 2403 if (llvm::Function *Fn = dyn_cast_or_null<llvm::Function>(GV)) { 2404 2405 if (CGM.getCodeGenOpts().StackProbeSize != 4096) 2406 Fn->addFnAttr("stack-probe-size", 2407 llvm::utostr(CGM.getCodeGenOpts().StackProbeSize)); 2408 if (CGM.getCodeGenOpts().NoStackArgProbe) 2409 Fn->addFnAttr("no-stack-arg-probe"); 2410 } 2411 } 2412 2413 void WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 2414 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 2415 X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 2416 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 2417 return; 2418 addStackProbeTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 2419 } 2420 2421 class WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 2422 public: 2423 WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, 2424 X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) 2425 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new WinX86_64ABIInfo(CGT)) {} 2426 2427 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2428 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 2429 2430 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2431 return 7; 2432 } 2433 2434 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 2435 llvm::Value *Address) const override { 2436 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 8); 2437 2438 // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers. 2439 // 16 is %rip. 2440 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 16); 2441 return false; 2442 } 2443 2444 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 2445 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 2446 Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:"; 2447 Opt += qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib); 2448 } 2449 2450 void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, 2451 llvm::StringRef Value, 2452 llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override { 2453 Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\""; 2454 } 2455 }; 2456 2457 void WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 2458 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 2459 TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 2460 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 2461 return; 2462 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2463 if (FD->hasAttr<X86ForceAlignArgPointerAttr>()) { 2464 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 2465 Fn->addFnAttr("stackrealign"); 2466 } 2467 if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 2468 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 2469 Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR); 2470 } 2471 } 2472 2473 addStackProbeTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 2474 } 2475 } 2476 2477 void X86_64ABIInfo::postMerge(unsigned AggregateSize, Class &Lo, 2478 Class &Hi) const { 2479 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 5. Then a post merger cleanup is done: 2480 // 2481 // (a) If one of the classes is Memory, the whole argument is passed in 2482 // memory. 2483 // 2484 // (b) If X87UP is not preceded by X87, the whole argument is passed in 2485 // memory. 2486 // 2487 // (c) If the size of the aggregate exceeds two eightbytes and the first 2488 // eightbyte isn't SSE or any other eightbyte isn't SSEUP, the whole 2489 // argument is passed in memory. NOTE: This is necessary to keep the 2490 // ABI working for processors that don't support the __m256 type. 2491 // 2492 // (d) If SSEUP is not preceded by SSE or SSEUP, it is converted to SSE. 2493 // 2494 // Some of these are enforced by the merging logic. Others can arise 2495 // only with unions; for example: 2496 // union { _Complex double; unsigned; } 2497 // 2498 // Note that clauses (b) and (c) were added in 0.98. 2499 // 2500 if (Hi == Memory) 2501 Lo = Memory; 2502 if (Hi == X87Up && Lo != X87 && honorsRevision0_98()) 2503 Lo = Memory; 2504 if (AggregateSize > 128 && (Lo != SSE || Hi != SSEUp)) 2505 Lo = Memory; 2506 if (Hi == SSEUp && Lo != SSE) 2507 Hi = SSE; 2508 } 2509 2510 X86_64ABIInfo::Class X86_64ABIInfo::merge(Class Accum, Class Field) { 2511 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 4. Each field of an object is 2512 // classified recursively so that always two fields are 2513 // considered. The resulting class is calculated according to 2514 // the classes of the fields in the eightbyte: 2515 // 2516 // (a) If both classes are equal, this is the resulting class. 2517 // 2518 // (b) If one of the classes is NO_CLASS, the resulting class is 2519 // the other class. 2520 // 2521 // (c) If one of the classes is MEMORY, the result is the MEMORY 2522 // class. 2523 // 2524 // (d) If one of the classes is INTEGER, the result is the 2525 // INTEGER. 2526 // 2527 // (e) If one of the classes is X87, X87UP, COMPLEX_X87 class, 2528 // MEMORY is used as class. 2529 // 2530 // (f) Otherwise class SSE is used. 2531 2532 // Accum should never be memory (we should have returned) or 2533 // ComplexX87 (because this cannot be passed in a structure). 2534 assert((Accum != Memory && Accum != ComplexX87) && 2535 "Invalid accumulated classification during merge."); 2536 if (Accum == Field || Field == NoClass) 2537 return Accum; 2538 if (Field == Memory) 2539 return Memory; 2540 if (Accum == NoClass) 2541 return Field; 2542 if (Accum == Integer || Field == Integer) 2543 return Integer; 2544 if (Field == X87 || Field == X87Up || Field == ComplexX87 || 2545 Accum == X87 || Accum == X87Up) 2546 return Memory; 2547 return SSE; 2548 } 2549 2550 void X86_64ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty, uint64_t OffsetBase, 2551 Class &Lo, Class &Hi, bool isNamedArg) const { 2552 // FIXME: This code can be simplified by introducing a simple value class for 2553 // Class pairs with appropriate constructor methods for the various 2554 // situations. 2555 2556 // FIXME: Some of the split computations are wrong; unaligned vectors 2557 // shouldn't be passed in registers for example, so there is no chance they 2558 // can straddle an eightbyte. Verify & simplify. 2559 2560 Lo = Hi = NoClass; 2561 2562 Class &Current = OffsetBase < 64 ? Lo : Hi; 2563 Current = Memory; 2564 2565 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 2566 BuiltinType::Kind k = BT->getKind(); 2567 2568 if (k == BuiltinType::Void) { 2569 Current = NoClass; 2570 } else if (k == BuiltinType::Int128 || k == BuiltinType::UInt128) { 2571 Lo = Integer; 2572 Hi = Integer; 2573 } else if (k >= BuiltinType::Bool && k <= BuiltinType::LongLong) { 2574 Current = Integer; 2575 } else if (k == BuiltinType::Float || k == BuiltinType::Double) { 2576 Current = SSE; 2577 } else if (k == BuiltinType::LongDouble) { 2578 const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat(); 2579 if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad()) { 2580 Lo = SSE; 2581 Hi = SSEUp; 2582 } else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended()) { 2583 Lo = X87; 2584 Hi = X87Up; 2585 } else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble()) { 2586 Current = SSE; 2587 } else 2588 llvm_unreachable("unexpected long double representation!"); 2589 } 2590 // FIXME: _Decimal32 and _Decimal64 are SSE. 2591 // FIXME: _float128 and _Decimal128 are (SSE, SSEUp). 2592 return; 2593 } 2594 2595 if (const EnumType *ET = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) { 2596 // Classify the underlying integer type. 2597 classify(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(), OffsetBase, Lo, Hi, isNamedArg); 2598 return; 2599 } 2600 2601 if (Ty->hasPointerRepresentation()) { 2602 Current = Integer; 2603 return; 2604 } 2605 2606 if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 2607 if (Ty->isMemberFunctionPointerType()) { 2608 if (Has64BitPointers) { 2609 // If Has64BitPointers, this is an {i64, i64}, so classify both 2610 // Lo and Hi now. 2611 Lo = Hi = Integer; 2612 } else { 2613 // Otherwise, with 32-bit pointers, this is an {i32, i32}. If that 2614 // straddles an eightbyte boundary, Hi should be classified as well. 2615 uint64_t EB_FuncPtr = (OffsetBase) / 64; 2616 uint64_t EB_ThisAdj = (OffsetBase + 64 - 1) / 64; 2617 if (EB_FuncPtr != EB_ThisAdj) { 2618 Lo = Hi = Integer; 2619 } else { 2620 Current = Integer; 2621 } 2622 } 2623 } else { 2624 Current = Integer; 2625 } 2626 return; 2627 } 2628 2629 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 2630 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 2631 if (Size == 1 || Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) { 2632 // gcc passes the following as integer: 2633 // 4 bytes - <4 x char>, <2 x short>, <1 x int>, <1 x float> 2634 // 2 bytes - <2 x char>, <1 x short> 2635 // 1 byte - <1 x char> 2636 Current = Integer; 2637 2638 // If this type crosses an eightbyte boundary, it should be 2639 // split. 2640 uint64_t EB_Lo = (OffsetBase) / 64; 2641 uint64_t EB_Hi = (OffsetBase + Size - 1) / 64; 2642 if (EB_Lo != EB_Hi) 2643 Hi = Lo; 2644 } else if (Size == 64) { 2645 QualType ElementType = VT->getElementType(); 2646 2647 // gcc passes <1 x double> in memory. :( 2648 if (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double)) 2649 return; 2650 2651 // gcc passes <1 x long long> as SSE but clang used to unconditionally 2652 // pass them as integer. For platforms where clang is the de facto 2653 // platform compiler, we must continue to use integer. 2654 if (!classifyIntegerMMXAsSSE() && 2655 (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) || 2656 ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong) || 2657 ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Long) || 2658 ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULong))) 2659 Current = Integer; 2660 else 2661 Current = SSE; 2662 2663 // If this type crosses an eightbyte boundary, it should be 2664 // split. 2665 if (OffsetBase && OffsetBase != 64) 2666 Hi = Lo; 2667 } else if (Size == 128 || 2668 (isNamedArg && Size <= getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) { 2669 // Arguments of 256-bits are split into four eightbyte chunks. The 2670 // least significant one belongs to class SSE and all the others to class 2671 // SSEUP. The original Lo and Hi design considers that types can't be 2672 // greater than 128-bits, so a 64-bit split in Hi and Lo makes sense. 2673 // This design isn't correct for 256-bits, but since there're no cases 2674 // where the upper parts would need to be inspected, avoid adding 2675 // complexity and just consider Hi to match the 64-256 part. 2676 // 2677 // Note that per 3.5.7 of AMD64-ABI, 256-bit args are only passed in 2678 // registers if they are "named", i.e. not part of the "..." of a 2679 // variadic function. 2680 // 2681 // Similarly, per 3.2.3. of the AVX512 draft, 512-bits ("named") args are 2682 // split into eight eightbyte chunks, one SSE and seven SSEUP. 2683 Lo = SSE; 2684 Hi = SSEUp; 2685 } 2686 return; 2687 } 2688 2689 if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 2690 QualType ET = getContext().getCanonicalType(CT->getElementType()); 2691 2692 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2693 if (ET->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 2694 if (Size <= 64) 2695 Current = Integer; 2696 else if (Size <= 128) 2697 Lo = Hi = Integer; 2698 } else if (ET == getContext().FloatTy) { 2699 Current = SSE; 2700 } else if (ET == getContext().DoubleTy) { 2701 Lo = Hi = SSE; 2702 } else if (ET == getContext().LongDoubleTy) { 2703 const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat(); 2704 if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad()) 2705 Current = Memory; 2706 else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended()) 2707 Current = ComplexX87; 2708 else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble()) 2709 Lo = Hi = SSE; 2710 else 2711 llvm_unreachable("unexpected long double representation!"); 2712 } 2713 2714 // If this complex type crosses an eightbyte boundary then it 2715 // should be split. 2716 uint64_t EB_Real = (OffsetBase) / 64; 2717 uint64_t EB_Imag = (OffsetBase + getContext().getTypeSize(ET)) / 64; 2718 if (Hi == NoClass && EB_Real != EB_Imag) 2719 Hi = Lo; 2720 2721 return; 2722 } 2723 2724 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) { 2725 // Arrays are treated like structures. 2726 2727 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2728 2729 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger 2730 // than eight eightbytes, ..., it has class MEMORY. 2731 if (Size > 512) 2732 return; 2733 2734 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If ..., or it contains unaligned 2735 // fields, it has class MEMORY. 2736 // 2737 // Only need to check alignment of array base. 2738 if (OffsetBase % getContext().getTypeAlign(AT->getElementType())) 2739 return; 2740 2741 // Otherwise implement simplified merge. We could be smarter about 2742 // this, but it isn't worth it and would be harder to verify. 2743 Current = NoClass; 2744 uint64_t EltSize = getContext().getTypeSize(AT->getElementType()); 2745 uint64_t ArraySize = AT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 2746 2747 // The only case a 256-bit wide vector could be used is when the array 2748 // contains a single 256-bit element. Since Lo and Hi logic isn't extended 2749 // to work for sizes wider than 128, early check and fallback to memory. 2750 // 2751 if (Size > 128 && 2752 (Size != EltSize || Size > getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) 2753 return; 2754 2755 for (uint64_t i=0, Offset=OffsetBase; i<ArraySize; ++i, Offset += EltSize) { 2756 Class FieldLo, FieldHi; 2757 classify(AT->getElementType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg); 2758 Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo); 2759 Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi); 2760 if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) 2761 break; 2762 } 2763 2764 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2765 assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp array classification."); 2766 return; 2767 } 2768 2769 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 2770 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2771 2772 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger 2773 // than eight eightbytes, ..., it has class MEMORY. 2774 if (Size > 512) 2775 return; 2776 2777 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 2. If a C++ object has either a non-trivial 2778 // copy constructor or a non-trivial destructor, it is passed by invisible 2779 // reference. 2780 if (getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI())) 2781 return; 2782 2783 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 2784 2785 // Assume variable sized types are passed in memory. 2786 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 2787 return; 2788 2789 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD); 2790 2791 // Reset Lo class, this will be recomputed. 2792 Current = NoClass; 2793 2794 // If this is a C++ record, classify the bases first. 2795 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 2796 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 2797 assert(!I.isVirtual() && !I.getType()->isDependentType() && 2798 "Unexpected base class!"); 2799 const CXXRecordDecl *Base = 2800 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(I.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 2801 2802 // Classify this field. 2803 // 2804 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 3. If the size of the aggregate exceeds a 2805 // single eightbyte, each is classified separately. Each eightbyte gets 2806 // initialized to class NO_CLASS. 2807 Class FieldLo, FieldHi; 2808 uint64_t Offset = 2809 OffsetBase + getContext().toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base)); 2810 classify(I.getType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg); 2811 Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo); 2812 Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi); 2813 if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) { 2814 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2815 return; 2816 } 2817 } 2818 } 2819 2820 // Classify the fields one at a time, merging the results. 2821 unsigned idx = 0; 2822 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 2823 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 2824 uint64_t Offset = OffsetBase + Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 2825 bool BitField = i->isBitField(); 2826 2827 // Ignore padding bit-fields. 2828 if (BitField && i->isUnnamedBitfield()) 2829 continue; 2830 2831 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger than 2832 // four eightbytes, or it contains unaligned fields, it has class MEMORY. 2833 // 2834 // The only case a 256-bit wide vector could be used is when the struct 2835 // contains a single 256-bit element. Since Lo and Hi logic isn't extended 2836 // to work for sizes wider than 128, early check and fallback to memory. 2837 // 2838 if (Size > 128 && (Size != getContext().getTypeSize(i->getType()) || 2839 Size > getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) { 2840 Lo = Memory; 2841 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2842 return; 2843 } 2844 // Note, skip this test for bit-fields, see below. 2845 if (!BitField && Offset % getContext().getTypeAlign(i->getType())) { 2846 Lo = Memory; 2847 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2848 return; 2849 } 2850 2851 // Classify this field. 2852 // 2853 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 3. If the size of the aggregate 2854 // exceeds a single eightbyte, each is classified 2855 // separately. Each eightbyte gets initialized to class 2856 // NO_CLASS. 2857 Class FieldLo, FieldHi; 2858 2859 // Bit-fields require special handling, they do not force the 2860 // structure to be passed in memory even if unaligned, and 2861 // therefore they can straddle an eightbyte. 2862 if (BitField) { 2863 assert(!i->isUnnamedBitfield()); 2864 uint64_t Offset = OffsetBase + Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 2865 uint64_t Size = i->getBitWidthValue(getContext()); 2866 2867 uint64_t EB_Lo = Offset / 64; 2868 uint64_t EB_Hi = (Offset + Size - 1) / 64; 2869 2870 if (EB_Lo) { 2871 assert(EB_Hi == EB_Lo && "Invalid classification, type > 16 bytes."); 2872 FieldLo = NoClass; 2873 FieldHi = Integer; 2874 } else { 2875 FieldLo = Integer; 2876 FieldHi = EB_Hi ? Integer : NoClass; 2877 } 2878 } else 2879 classify(i->getType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg); 2880 Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo); 2881 Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi); 2882 if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) 2883 break; 2884 } 2885 2886 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2887 } 2888 } 2889 2890 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty) const { 2891 // If this is a scalar LLVM value then assume LLVM will pass it in the right 2892 // place naturally. 2893 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 2894 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 2895 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 2896 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2897 2898 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty) 2899 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 2900 } 2901 2902 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty); 2903 } 2904 2905 bool X86_64ABIInfo::IsIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 2906 if (const VectorType *VecTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 2907 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VecTy); 2908 unsigned LargestVector = getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel); 2909 if (Size <= 64 || Size > LargestVector) 2910 return true; 2911 } 2912 2913 return false; 2914 } 2915 2916 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, 2917 unsigned freeIntRegs) const { 2918 // If this is a scalar LLVM value then assume LLVM will pass it in the right 2919 // place naturally. 2920 // 2921 // This assumption is optimistic, as there could be free registers available 2922 // when we need to pass this argument in memory, and LLVM could try to pass 2923 // the argument in the free register. This does not seem to happen currently, 2924 // but this code would be much safer if we could mark the argument with 2925 // 'onstack'. See PR12193. 2926 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !IsIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 2927 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 2928 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 2929 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2930 2931 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty) 2932 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 2933 } 2934 2935 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 2936 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 2937 2938 // Compute the byval alignment. We specify the alignment of the byval in all 2939 // cases so that the mid-level optimizer knows the alignment of the byval. 2940 unsigned Align = std::max(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8, 8U); 2941 2942 // Attempt to avoid passing indirect results using byval when possible. This 2943 // is important for good codegen. 2944 // 2945 // We do this by coercing the value into a scalar type which the backend can 2946 // handle naturally (i.e., without using byval). 2947 // 2948 // For simplicity, we currently only do this when we have exhausted all of the 2949 // free integer registers. Doing this when there are free integer registers 2950 // would require more care, as we would have to ensure that the coerced value 2951 // did not claim the unused register. That would require either reording the 2952 // arguments to the function (so that any subsequent inreg values came first), 2953 // or only doing this optimization when there were no following arguments that 2954 // might be inreg. 2955 // 2956 // We currently expect it to be rare (particularly in well written code) for 2957 // arguments to be passed on the stack when there are still free integer 2958 // registers available (this would typically imply large structs being passed 2959 // by value), so this seems like a fair tradeoff for now. 2960 // 2961 // We can revisit this if the backend grows support for 'onstack' parameter 2962 // attributes. See PR12193. 2963 if (freeIntRegs == 0) { 2964 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2965 2966 // If this type fits in an eightbyte, coerce it into the matching integral 2967 // type, which will end up on the stack (with alignment 8). 2968 if (Align == 8 && Size <= 64) 2969 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 2970 Size)); 2971 } 2972 2973 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align)); 2974 } 2975 2976 /// The ABI specifies that a value should be passed in a full vector XMM/YMM 2977 /// register. Pick an LLVM IR type that will be passed as a vector register. 2978 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo::GetByteVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 2979 // Wrapper structs/arrays that only contain vectors are passed just like 2980 // vectors; strip them off if present. 2981 if (const Type *InnerTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext())) 2982 Ty = QualType(InnerTy, 0); 2983 2984 llvm::Type *IRType = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 2985 if (isa<llvm::VectorType>(IRType) || 2986 IRType->getTypeID() == llvm::Type::FP128TyID) 2987 return IRType; 2988 2989 // We couldn't find the preferred IR vector type for 'Ty'. 2990 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2991 assert((Size == 128 || Size == 256 || Size == 512) && "Invalid type found!"); 2992 2993 // Return a LLVM IR vector type based on the size of 'Ty'. 2994 return llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()), 2995 Size / 64); 2996 } 2997 2998 /// BitsContainNoUserData - Return true if the specified [start,end) bit range 2999 /// is known to either be off the end of the specified type or being in 3000 /// alignment padding. The user type specified is known to be at most 128 bits 3001 /// in size, and have passed through X86_64ABIInfo::classify with a successful 3002 /// classification that put one of the two halves in the INTEGER class. 3003 /// 3004 /// It is conservatively correct to return false. 3005 static bool BitsContainNoUserData(QualType Ty, unsigned StartBit, 3006 unsigned EndBit, ASTContext &Context) { 3007 // If the bytes being queried are off the end of the type, there is no user 3008 // data hiding here. This handles analysis of builtins, vectors and other 3009 // types that don't contain interesting padding. 3010 unsigned TySize = (unsigned)Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 3011 if (TySize <= StartBit) 3012 return true; 3013 3014 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) { 3015 unsigned EltSize = (unsigned)Context.getTypeSize(AT->getElementType()); 3016 unsigned NumElts = (unsigned)AT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 3017 3018 // Check each element to see if the element overlaps with the queried range. 3019 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) { 3020 // If the element is after the span we care about, then we're done.. 3021 unsigned EltOffset = i*EltSize; 3022 if (EltOffset >= EndBit) break; 3023 3024 unsigned EltStart = EltOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-EltOffset :0; 3025 if (!BitsContainNoUserData(AT->getElementType(), EltStart, 3026 EndBit-EltOffset, Context)) 3027 return false; 3028 } 3029 // If it overlaps no elements, then it is safe to process as padding. 3030 return true; 3031 } 3032 3033 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3034 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 3035 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD); 3036 3037 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 3038 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 3039 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 3040 assert(!I.isVirtual() && !I.getType()->isDependentType() && 3041 "Unexpected base class!"); 3042 const CXXRecordDecl *Base = 3043 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(I.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 3044 3045 // If the base is after the span we care about, ignore it. 3046 unsigned BaseOffset = Context.toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base)); 3047 if (BaseOffset >= EndBit) continue; 3048 3049 unsigned BaseStart = BaseOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-BaseOffset :0; 3050 if (!BitsContainNoUserData(I.getType(), BaseStart, 3051 EndBit-BaseOffset, Context)) 3052 return false; 3053 } 3054 } 3055 3056 // Verify that no field has data that overlaps the region of interest. Yes 3057 // this could be sped up a lot by being smarter about queried fields, 3058 // however we're only looking at structs up to 16 bytes, so we don't care 3059 // much. 3060 unsigned idx = 0; 3061 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 3062 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 3063 unsigned FieldOffset = (unsigned)Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 3064 3065 // If we found a field after the region we care about, then we're done. 3066 if (FieldOffset >= EndBit) break; 3067 3068 unsigned FieldStart = FieldOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-FieldOffset :0; 3069 if (!BitsContainNoUserData(i->getType(), FieldStart, EndBit-FieldOffset, 3070 Context)) 3071 return false; 3072 } 3073 3074 // If nothing in this record overlapped the area of interest, then we're 3075 // clean. 3076 return true; 3077 } 3078 3079 return false; 3080 } 3081 3082 /// ContainsFloatAtOffset - Return true if the specified LLVM IR type has a 3083 /// float member at the specified offset. For example, {int,{float}} has a 3084 /// float at offset 4. It is conservatively correct for this routine to return 3085 /// false. 3086 static bool ContainsFloatAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset, 3087 const llvm::DataLayout &TD) { 3088 // Base case if we find a float. 3089 if (IROffset == 0 && IRType->isFloatTy()) 3090 return true; 3091 3092 // If this is a struct, recurse into the field at the specified offset. 3093 if (llvm::StructType *STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(IRType)) { 3094 const llvm::StructLayout *SL = TD.getStructLayout(STy); 3095 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(IROffset); 3096 IROffset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt); 3097 return ContainsFloatAtOffset(STy->getElementType(Elt), IROffset, TD); 3098 } 3099 3100 // If this is an array, recurse into the field at the specified offset. 3101 if (llvm::ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(IRType)) { 3102 llvm::Type *EltTy = ATy->getElementType(); 3103 unsigned EltSize = TD.getTypeAllocSize(EltTy); 3104 IROffset -= IROffset/EltSize*EltSize; 3105 return ContainsFloatAtOffset(EltTy, IROffset, TD); 3106 } 3107 3108 return false; 3109 } 3110 3111 3112 /// GetSSETypeAtOffset - Return a type that will be passed by the backend in the 3113 /// low 8 bytes of an XMM register, corresponding to the SSE class. 3114 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo:: 3115 GetSSETypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset, 3116 QualType SourceTy, unsigned SourceOffset) const { 3117 // The only three choices we have are either double, <2 x float>, or float. We 3118 // pass as float if the last 4 bytes is just padding. This happens for 3119 // structs that contain 3 floats. 3120 if (BitsContainNoUserData(SourceTy, SourceOffset*8+32, 3121 SourceOffset*8+64, getContext())) 3122 return llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()); 3123 3124 // We want to pass as <2 x float> if the LLVM IR type contains a float at 3125 // offset+0 and offset+4. Walk the LLVM IR type to find out if this is the 3126 // case. 3127 if (ContainsFloatAtOffset(IRType, IROffset, getDataLayout()) && 3128 ContainsFloatAtOffset(IRType, IROffset+4, getDataLayout())) 3129 return llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()), 2); 3130 3131 return llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()); 3132 } 3133 3134 3135 /// GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset - The ABI specifies that a value should be passed in 3136 /// an 8-byte GPR. This means that we either have a scalar or we are talking 3137 /// about the high or low part of an up-to-16-byte struct. This routine picks 3138 /// the best LLVM IR type to represent this, which may be i64 or may be anything 3139 /// else that the backend will pass in a GPR that works better (e.g. i8, %foo*, 3140 /// etc). 3141 /// 3142 /// PrefType is an LLVM IR type that corresponds to (part of) the IR type for 3143 /// the source type. IROffset is an offset in bytes into the LLVM IR type that 3144 /// the 8-byte value references. PrefType may be null. 3145 /// 3146 /// SourceTy is the source-level type for the entire argument. SourceOffset is 3147 /// an offset into this that we're processing (which is always either 0 or 8). 3148 /// 3149 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo:: 3150 GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset, 3151 QualType SourceTy, unsigned SourceOffset) const { 3152 // If we're dealing with an un-offset LLVM IR type, then it means that we're 3153 // returning an 8-byte unit starting with it. See if we can safely use it. 3154 if (IROffset == 0) { 3155 // Pointers and int64's always fill the 8-byte unit. 3156 if ((isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) && Has64BitPointers) || 3157 IRType->isIntegerTy(64)) 3158 return IRType; 3159 3160 // If we have a 1/2/4-byte integer, we can use it only if the rest of the 3161 // goodness in the source type is just tail padding. This is allowed to 3162 // kick in for struct {double,int} on the int, but not on 3163 // struct{double,int,int} because we wouldn't return the second int. We 3164 // have to do this analysis on the source type because we can't depend on 3165 // unions being lowered a specific way etc. 3166 if (IRType->isIntegerTy(8) || IRType->isIntegerTy(16) || 3167 IRType->isIntegerTy(32) || 3168 (isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) && !Has64BitPointers)) { 3169 unsigned BitWidth = isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) ? 32 : 3170 cast<llvm::IntegerType>(IRType)->getBitWidth(); 3171 3172 if (BitsContainNoUserData(SourceTy, SourceOffset*8+BitWidth, 3173 SourceOffset*8+64, getContext())) 3174 return IRType; 3175 } 3176 } 3177 3178 if (llvm::StructType *STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(IRType)) { 3179 // If this is a struct, recurse into the field at the specified offset. 3180 const llvm::StructLayout *SL = getDataLayout().getStructLayout(STy); 3181 if (IROffset < SL->getSizeInBytes()) { 3182 unsigned FieldIdx = SL->getElementContainingOffset(IROffset); 3183 IROffset -= SL->getElementOffset(FieldIdx); 3184 3185 return GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(STy->getElementType(FieldIdx), IROffset, 3186 SourceTy, SourceOffset); 3187 } 3188 } 3189 3190 if (llvm::ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(IRType)) { 3191 llvm::Type *EltTy = ATy->getElementType(); 3192 unsigned EltSize = getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(EltTy); 3193 unsigned EltOffset = IROffset/EltSize*EltSize; 3194 return GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(EltTy, IROffset-EltOffset, SourceTy, 3195 SourceOffset); 3196 } 3197 3198 // Okay, we don't have any better idea of what to pass, so we pass this in an 3199 // integer register that isn't too big to fit the rest of the struct. 3200 unsigned TySizeInBytes = 3201 (unsigned)getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(SourceTy).getQuantity(); 3202 3203 assert(TySizeInBytes != SourceOffset && "Empty field?"); 3204 3205 // It is always safe to classify this as an integer type up to i64 that 3206 // isn't larger than the structure. 3207 return llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 3208 std::min(TySizeInBytes-SourceOffset, 8U)*8); 3209 } 3210 3211 3212 /// GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair - Given a high and low type that can ideally 3213 /// be used as elements of a two register pair to pass or return, return a 3214 /// first class aggregate to represent them. For example, if the low part of 3215 /// a by-value argument should be passed as i32* and the high part as float, 3216 /// return {i32*, float}. 3217 static llvm::Type * 3218 GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(llvm::Type *Lo, llvm::Type *Hi, 3219 const llvm::DataLayout &TD) { 3220 // In order to correctly satisfy the ABI, we need to the high part to start 3221 // at offset 8. If the high and low parts we inferred are both 4-byte types 3222 // (e.g. i32 and i32) then the resultant struct type ({i32,i32}) won't have 3223 // the second element at offset 8. Check for this: 3224 unsigned LoSize = (unsigned)TD.getTypeAllocSize(Lo); 3225 unsigned HiAlign = TD.getABITypeAlignment(Hi); 3226 unsigned HiStart = llvm::alignTo(LoSize, HiAlign); 3227 assert(HiStart != 0 && HiStart <= 8 && "Invalid x86-64 argument pair!"); 3228 3229 // To handle this, we have to increase the size of the low part so that the 3230 // second element will start at an 8 byte offset. We can't increase the size 3231 // of the second element because it might make us access off the end of the 3232 // struct. 3233 if (HiStart != 8) { 3234 // There are usually two sorts of types the ABI generation code can produce 3235 // for the low part of a pair that aren't 8 bytes in size: float or 3236 // i8/i16/i32. This can also include pointers when they are 32-bit (X32 and 3237 // NaCl). 3238 // Promote these to a larger type. 3239 if (Lo->isFloatTy()) 3240 Lo = llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(Lo->getContext()); 3241 else { 3242 assert((Lo->isIntegerTy() || Lo->isPointerTy()) 3243 && "Invalid/unknown lo type"); 3244 Lo = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(Lo->getContext()); 3245 } 3246 } 3247 3248 llvm::StructType *Result = llvm::StructType::get(Lo, Hi); 3249 3250 // Verify that the second element is at an 8-byte offset. 3251 assert(TD.getStructLayout(Result)->getElementOffset(1) == 8 && 3252 "Invalid x86-64 argument pair!"); 3253 return Result; 3254 } 3255 3256 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo:: 3257 classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 3258 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 1. Classify the return type with the 3259 // classification algorithm. 3260 X86_64ABIInfo::Class Lo, Hi; 3261 classify(RetTy, 0, Lo, Hi, /*isNamedArg*/ true); 3262 3263 // Check some invariants. 3264 assert((Hi != Memory || Lo == Memory) && "Invalid memory classification."); 3265 assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp classification."); 3266 3267 llvm::Type *ResType = nullptr; 3268 switch (Lo) { 3269 case NoClass: 3270 if (Hi == NoClass) 3271 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 3272 // If the low part is just padding, it takes no register, leave ResType 3273 // null. 3274 assert((Hi == SSE || Hi == Integer || Hi == X87Up) && 3275 "Unknown missing lo part"); 3276 break; 3277 3278 case SSEUp: 3279 case X87Up: 3280 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for lo word."); 3281 3282 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 2. Types of class memory are returned via 3283 // hidden argument. 3284 case Memory: 3285 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy); 3286 3287 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 3. If the class is INTEGER, the next 3288 // available register of the sequence %rax, %rdx is used. 3289 case Integer: 3290 ResType = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 0, RetTy, 0); 3291 3292 // If we have a sign or zero extended integer, make sure to return Extend 3293 // so that the parameter gets the right LLVM IR attributes. 3294 if (Hi == NoClass && isa<llvm::IntegerType>(ResType)) { 3295 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 3296 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 3297 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 3298 3299 if (RetTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 3300 RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) 3301 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy); 3302 } 3303 break; 3304 3305 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 4. If the class is SSE, the next 3306 // available SSE register of the sequence %xmm0, %xmm1 is used. 3307 case SSE: 3308 ResType = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 0, RetTy, 0); 3309 break; 3310 3311 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 6. If the class is X87, the value is 3312 // returned on the X87 stack in %st0 as 80-bit x87 number. 3313 case X87: 3314 ResType = llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()); 3315 break; 3316 3317 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 8. If the class is COMPLEX_X87, the real 3318 // part of the value is returned in %st0 and the imaginary part in 3319 // %st1. 3320 case ComplexX87: 3321 assert(Hi == ComplexX87 && "Unexpected ComplexX87 classification."); 3322 ResType = llvm::StructType::get(llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()), 3323 llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext())); 3324 break; 3325 } 3326 3327 llvm::Type *HighPart = nullptr; 3328 switch (Hi) { 3329 // Memory was handled previously and X87 should 3330 // never occur as a hi class. 3331 case Memory: 3332 case X87: 3333 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for hi word."); 3334 3335 case ComplexX87: // Previously handled. 3336 case NoClass: 3337 break; 3338 3339 case Integer: 3340 HighPart = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8); 3341 if (Lo == NoClass) // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3342 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3343 break; 3344 case SSE: 3345 HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8); 3346 if (Lo == NoClass) // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3347 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3348 break; 3349 3350 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 5. If the class is SSEUP, the eightbyte 3351 // is passed in the next available eightbyte chunk if the last used 3352 // vector register. 3353 // 3354 // SSEUP should always be preceded by SSE, just widen. 3355 case SSEUp: 3356 assert(Lo == SSE && "Unexpected SSEUp classification."); 3357 ResType = GetByteVectorType(RetTy); 3358 break; 3359 3360 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 7. If the class is X87UP, the value is 3361 // returned together with the previous X87 value in %st0. 3362 case X87Up: 3363 // If X87Up is preceded by X87, we don't need to do 3364 // anything. However, in some cases with unions it may not be 3365 // preceded by X87. In such situations we follow gcc and pass the 3366 // extra bits in an SSE reg. 3367 if (Lo != X87) { 3368 HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8); 3369 if (Lo == NoClass) // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3370 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3371 } 3372 break; 3373 } 3374 3375 // If a high part was specified, merge it together with the low part. It is 3376 // known to pass in the high eightbyte of the result. We do this by forming a 3377 // first class struct aggregate with the high and low part: {low, high} 3378 if (HighPart) 3379 ResType = GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(ResType, HighPart, getDataLayout()); 3380 3381 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 3382 } 3383 3384 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType( 3385 QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs, unsigned &neededInt, unsigned &neededSSE, 3386 bool isNamedArg) 3387 const 3388 { 3389 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 3390 3391 X86_64ABIInfo::Class Lo, Hi; 3392 classify(Ty, 0, Lo, Hi, isNamedArg); 3393 3394 // Check some invariants. 3395 // FIXME: Enforce these by construction. 3396 assert((Hi != Memory || Lo == Memory) && "Invalid memory classification."); 3397 assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp classification."); 3398 3399 neededInt = 0; 3400 neededSSE = 0; 3401 llvm::Type *ResType = nullptr; 3402 switch (Lo) { 3403 case NoClass: 3404 if (Hi == NoClass) 3405 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 3406 // If the low part is just padding, it takes no register, leave ResType 3407 // null. 3408 assert((Hi == SSE || Hi == Integer || Hi == X87Up) && 3409 "Unknown missing lo part"); 3410 break; 3411 3412 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 1. If the class is MEMORY, pass the argument 3413 // on the stack. 3414 case Memory: 3415 3416 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 5. If the class is X87, X87UP or 3417 // COMPLEX_X87, it is passed in memory. 3418 case X87: 3419 case ComplexX87: 3420 if (getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()) == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) 3421 ++neededInt; 3422 return getIndirectResult(Ty, freeIntRegs); 3423 3424 case SSEUp: 3425 case X87Up: 3426 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for lo word."); 3427 3428 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 2. If the class is INTEGER, the next 3429 // available register of the sequence %rdi, %rsi, %rdx, %rcx, %r8 3430 // and %r9 is used. 3431 case Integer: 3432 ++neededInt; 3433 3434 // Pick an 8-byte type based on the preferred type. 3435 ResType = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 0, Ty, 0); 3436 3437 // If we have a sign or zero extended integer, make sure to return Extend 3438 // so that the parameter gets the right LLVM IR attributes. 3439 if (Hi == NoClass && isa<llvm::IntegerType>(ResType)) { 3440 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 3441 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 3442 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 3443 3444 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 3445 Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) 3446 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty); 3447 } 3448 3449 break; 3450 3451 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 3. If the class is SSE, the next 3452 // available SSE register is used, the registers are taken in the 3453 // order from %xmm0 to %xmm7. 3454 case SSE: { 3455 llvm::Type *IRType = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 3456 ResType = GetSSETypeAtOffset(IRType, 0, Ty, 0); 3457 ++neededSSE; 3458 break; 3459 } 3460 } 3461 3462 llvm::Type *HighPart = nullptr; 3463 switch (Hi) { 3464 // Memory was handled previously, ComplexX87 and X87 should 3465 // never occur as hi classes, and X87Up must be preceded by X87, 3466 // which is passed in memory. 3467 case Memory: 3468 case X87: 3469 case ComplexX87: 3470 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for hi word."); 3471 3472 case NoClass: break; 3473 3474 case Integer: 3475 ++neededInt; 3476 // Pick an 8-byte type based on the preferred type. 3477 HighPart = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 8, Ty, 8); 3478 3479 if (Lo == NoClass) // Pass HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3480 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3481 break; 3482 3483 // X87Up generally doesn't occur here (long double is passed in 3484 // memory), except in situations involving unions. 3485 case X87Up: 3486 case SSE: 3487 HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 8, Ty, 8); 3488 3489 if (Lo == NoClass) // Pass HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3490 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3491 3492 ++neededSSE; 3493 break; 3494 3495 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 4. If the class is SSEUP, the 3496 // eightbyte is passed in the upper half of the last used SSE 3497 // register. This only happens when 128-bit vectors are passed. 3498 case SSEUp: 3499 assert(Lo == SSE && "Unexpected SSEUp classification"); 3500 ResType = GetByteVectorType(Ty); 3501 break; 3502 } 3503 3504 // If a high part was specified, merge it together with the low part. It is 3505 // known to pass in the high eightbyte of the result. We do this by forming a 3506 // first class struct aggregate with the high and low part: {low, high} 3507 if (HighPart) 3508 ResType = GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(ResType, HighPart, getDataLayout()); 3509 3510 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 3511 } 3512 3513 ABIArgInfo 3514 X86_64ABIInfo::classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt, 3515 unsigned &NeededSSE) const { 3516 auto RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 3517 assert(RT && "classifyRegCallStructType only valid with struct types"); 3518 3519 if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 3520 return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty); 3521 3522 // Sum up bases 3523 if (auto CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl())) { 3524 if (CXXRD->isDynamicClass()) { 3525 NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0; 3526 return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty); 3527 } 3528 3529 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) 3530 if (classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(I.getType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE) 3531 .isIndirect()) { 3532 NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0; 3533 return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty); 3534 } 3535 } 3536 3537 // Sum up members 3538 for (const auto *FD : RT->getDecl()->fields()) { 3539 if (FD->getType()->isRecordType() && !FD->getType()->isUnionType()) { 3540 if (classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(FD->getType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE) 3541 .isIndirect()) { 3542 NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0; 3543 return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty); 3544 } 3545 } else { 3546 unsigned LocalNeededInt, LocalNeededSSE; 3547 if (classifyArgumentType(FD->getType(), UINT_MAX, LocalNeededInt, 3548 LocalNeededSSE, true) 3549 .isIndirect()) { 3550 NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0; 3551 return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty); 3552 } 3553 NeededInt += LocalNeededInt; 3554 NeededSSE += LocalNeededSSE; 3555 } 3556 } 3557 3558 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3559 } 3560 3561 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::classifyRegCallStructType(QualType Ty, 3562 unsigned &NeededInt, 3563 unsigned &NeededSSE) const { 3564 3565 NeededInt = 0; 3566 NeededSSE = 0; 3567 3568 return classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(Ty, NeededInt, NeededSSE); 3569 } 3570 3571 void X86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 3572 3573 const unsigned CallingConv = FI.getCallingConvention(); 3574 // It is possible to force Win64 calling convention on any x86_64 target by 3575 // using __attribute__((ms_abi)). In such case to correctly emit Win64 3576 // compatible code delegate this call to WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo. 3577 if (CallingConv == llvm::CallingConv::Win64) { 3578 WinX86_64ABIInfo Win64ABIInfo(CGT); 3579 Win64ABIInfo.computeInfo(FI); 3580 return; 3581 } 3582 3583 bool IsRegCall = CallingConv == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall; 3584 3585 // Keep track of the number of assigned registers. 3586 unsigned FreeIntRegs = IsRegCall ? 11 : 6; 3587 unsigned FreeSSERegs = IsRegCall ? 16 : 8; 3588 unsigned NeededInt, NeededSSE; 3589 3590 if (!::classifyReturnType(getCXXABI(), FI, *this)) { 3591 if (IsRegCall && FI.getReturnType()->getTypePtr()->isRecordType() && 3592 !FI.getReturnType()->getTypePtr()->isUnionType()) { 3593 FI.getReturnInfo() = 3594 classifyRegCallStructType(FI.getReturnType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE); 3595 if (FreeIntRegs >= NeededInt && FreeSSERegs >= NeededSSE) { 3596 FreeIntRegs -= NeededInt; 3597 FreeSSERegs -= NeededSSE; 3598 } else { 3599 FI.getReturnInfo() = getIndirectReturnResult(FI.getReturnType()); 3600 } 3601 } else if (IsRegCall && FI.getReturnType()->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 3602 // Complex Long Double Type is passed in Memory when Regcall 3603 // calling convention is used. 3604 const ComplexType *CT = FI.getReturnType()->getAs<ComplexType>(); 3605 if (getContext().getCanonicalType(CT->getElementType()) == 3606 getContext().LongDoubleTy) 3607 FI.getReturnInfo() = getIndirectReturnResult(FI.getReturnType()); 3608 } else 3609 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 3610 } 3611 3612 // If the return value is indirect, then the hidden argument is consuming one 3613 // integer register. 3614 if (FI.getReturnInfo().isIndirect()) 3615 --FreeIntRegs; 3616 3617 // The chain argument effectively gives us another free register. 3618 if (FI.isChainCall()) 3619 ++FreeIntRegs; 3620 3621 unsigned NumRequiredArgs = FI.getNumRequiredArgs(); 3622 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Once arguments are classified, the registers 3623 // get assigned (in left-to-right order) for passing as follows... 3624 unsigned ArgNo = 0; 3625 for (CGFunctionInfo::arg_iterator it = FI.arg_begin(), ie = FI.arg_end(); 3626 it != ie; ++it, ++ArgNo) { 3627 bool IsNamedArg = ArgNo < NumRequiredArgs; 3628 3629 if (IsRegCall && it->type->isStructureOrClassType()) 3630 it->info = classifyRegCallStructType(it->type, NeededInt, NeededSSE); 3631 else 3632 it->info = classifyArgumentType(it->type, FreeIntRegs, NeededInt, 3633 NeededSSE, IsNamedArg); 3634 3635 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: If there are no registers available for any 3636 // eightbyte of an argument, the whole argument is passed on the 3637 // stack. If registers have already been assigned for some 3638 // eightbytes of such an argument, the assignments get reverted. 3639 if (FreeIntRegs >= NeededInt && FreeSSERegs >= NeededSSE) { 3640 FreeIntRegs -= NeededInt; 3641 FreeSSERegs -= NeededSSE; 3642 } else { 3643 it->info = getIndirectResult(it->type, FreeIntRegs); 3644 } 3645 } 3646 } 3647 3648 static Address EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 3649 Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) { 3650 Address overflow_arg_area_p = 3651 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, "overflow_arg_area_p"); 3652 llvm::Value *overflow_arg_area = 3653 CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(overflow_arg_area_p, "overflow_arg_area"); 3654 3655 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 7. Align l->overflow_arg_area upwards to a 16 3656 // byte boundary if alignment needed by type exceeds 8 byte boundary. 3657 // It isn't stated explicitly in the standard, but in practice we use 3658 // alignment greater than 16 where necessary. 3659 CharUnits Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty); 3660 if (Align > CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)) { 3661 overflow_arg_area = emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, overflow_arg_area, 3662 Align); 3663 } 3664 3665 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 8. Fetch type from l->overflow_arg_area. 3666 llvm::Type *LTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 3667 llvm::Value *Res = 3668 CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(overflow_arg_area, 3669 llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(LTy)); 3670 3671 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 9. Set l->overflow_arg_area to: 3672 // l->overflow_arg_area + sizeof(type). 3673 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 10. Align l->overflow_arg_area upwards to 3674 // an 8 byte boundary. 3675 3676 uint64_t SizeInBytes = (CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 7) / 8; 3677 llvm::Value *Offset = 3678 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, (SizeInBytes + 7) & ~7); 3679 overflow_arg_area = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(overflow_arg_area, Offset, 3680 "overflow_arg_area.next"); 3681 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(overflow_arg_area, overflow_arg_area_p); 3682 3683 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 11. Return the fetched type. 3684 return Address(Res, Align); 3685 } 3686 3687 Address X86_64ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3688 QualType Ty) const { 3689 // Assume that va_list type is correct; should be pointer to LLVM type: 3690 // struct { 3691 // i32 gp_offset; 3692 // i32 fp_offset; 3693 // i8* overflow_arg_area; 3694 // i8* reg_save_area; 3695 // }; 3696 unsigned neededInt, neededSSE; 3697 3698 Ty = getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty); 3699 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty, 0, neededInt, neededSSE, 3700 /*isNamedArg*/false); 3701 3702 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 1. Determine whether type may be passed 3703 // in the registers. If not go to step 7. 3704 if (!neededInt && !neededSSE) 3705 return EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty); 3706 3707 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 2. Compute num_gp to hold the number of 3708 // general purpose registers needed to pass type and num_fp to hold 3709 // the number of floating point registers needed. 3710 3711 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 3. Verify whether arguments fit into 3712 // registers. In the case: l->gp_offset > 48 - num_gp * 8 or 3713 // l->fp_offset > 304 - num_fp * 16 go to step 7. 3714 // 3715 // NOTE: 304 is a typo, there are (6 * 8 + 8 * 16) = 176 bytes of 3716 // register save space). 3717 3718 llvm::Value *InRegs = nullptr; 3719 Address gp_offset_p = Address::invalid(), fp_offset_p = Address::invalid(); 3720 llvm::Value *gp_offset = nullptr, *fp_offset = nullptr; 3721 if (neededInt) { 3722 gp_offset_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 0, "gp_offset_p"); 3723 gp_offset = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(gp_offset_p, "gp_offset"); 3724 InRegs = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 48 - neededInt * 8); 3725 InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULE(gp_offset, InRegs, "fits_in_gp"); 3726 } 3727 3728 if (neededSSE) { 3729 fp_offset_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 1, "fp_offset_p"); 3730 fp_offset = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(fp_offset_p, "fp_offset"); 3731 llvm::Value *FitsInFP = 3732 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 176 - neededSSE * 16); 3733 FitsInFP = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULE(fp_offset, FitsInFP, "fits_in_fp"); 3734 InRegs = InRegs ? CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(InRegs, FitsInFP) : FitsInFP; 3735 } 3736 3737 llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg"); 3738 llvm::BasicBlock *InMemBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_mem"); 3739 llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end"); 3740 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, InMemBlock); 3741 3742 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in registers. 3743 3744 CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock); 3745 3746 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 4. Fetch type from l->reg_save_area with 3747 // an offset of l->gp_offset and/or l->fp_offset. This may require 3748 // copying to a temporary location in case the parameter is passed 3749 // in different register classes or requires an alignment greater 3750 // than 8 for general purpose registers and 16 for XMM registers. 3751 // 3752 // FIXME: This really results in shameful code when we end up needing to 3753 // collect arguments from different places; often what should result in a 3754 // simple assembling of a structure from scattered addresses has many more 3755 // loads than necessary. Can we clean this up? 3756 llvm::Type *LTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 3757 llvm::Value *RegSaveArea = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad( 3758 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3), "reg_save_area"); 3759 3760 Address RegAddr = Address::invalid(); 3761 if (neededInt && neededSSE) { 3762 // FIXME: Cleanup. 3763 assert(AI.isDirect() && "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs"); 3764 llvm::StructType *ST = cast<llvm::StructType>(AI.getCoerceToType()); 3765 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty); 3766 Tmp = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, ST); 3767 assert(ST->getNumElements() == 2 && "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs"); 3768 llvm::Type *TyLo = ST->getElementType(0); 3769 llvm::Type *TyHi = ST->getElementType(1); 3770 assert((TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ^ TyHi->isFPOrFPVectorTy()) && 3771 "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs"); 3772 llvm::Type *PTyLo = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(TyLo); 3773 llvm::Type *PTyHi = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(TyHi); 3774 llvm::Value *GPAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, gp_offset); 3775 llvm::Value *FPAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset); 3776 llvm::Value *RegLoAddr = TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ? FPAddr : GPAddr; 3777 llvm::Value *RegHiAddr = TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ? GPAddr : FPAddr; 3778 3779 // Copy the first element. 3780 // FIXME: Our choice of alignment here and below is probably pessimistic. 3781 llvm::Value *V = CGF.Builder.CreateAlignedLoad( 3782 TyLo, CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(RegLoAddr, PTyLo), 3783 CharUnits::fromQuantity(getDataLayout().getABITypeAlignment(TyLo))); 3784 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 0)); 3785 3786 // Copy the second element. 3787 V = CGF.Builder.CreateAlignedLoad( 3788 TyHi, CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(RegHiAddr, PTyHi), 3789 CharUnits::fromQuantity(getDataLayout().getABITypeAlignment(TyHi))); 3790 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 1)); 3791 3792 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, LTy); 3793 } else if (neededInt) { 3794 RegAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, gp_offset), 3795 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 3796 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, LTy); 3797 3798 // Copy to a temporary if necessary to ensure the appropriate alignment. 3799 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> SizeAlign = 3800 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 3801 uint64_t TySize = SizeAlign.first.getQuantity(); 3802 CharUnits TyAlign = SizeAlign.second; 3803 3804 // Copy into a temporary if the type is more aligned than the 3805 // register save area. 3806 if (TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) { 3807 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty); 3808 CGF.Builder.CreateMemCpy(Tmp, RegAddr, TySize, false); 3809 RegAddr = Tmp; 3810 } 3811 3812 } else if (neededSSE == 1) { 3813 RegAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset), 3814 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 3815 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, LTy); 3816 } else { 3817 assert(neededSSE == 2 && "Invalid number of needed registers!"); 3818 // SSE registers are spaced 16 bytes apart in the register save 3819 // area, we need to collect the two eightbytes together. 3820 // The ABI isn't explicit about this, but it seems reasonable 3821 // to assume that the slots are 16-byte aligned, since the stack is 3822 // naturally 16-byte aligned and the prologue is expected to store 3823 // all the SSE registers to the RSA. 3824 Address RegAddrLo = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset), 3825 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 3826 Address RegAddrHi = 3827 CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RegAddrLo, 3828 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 3829 llvm::Type *ST = AI.canHaveCoerceToType() 3830 ? AI.getCoerceToType() 3831 : llvm::StructType::get(CGF.DoubleTy, CGF.DoubleTy); 3832 llvm::Value *V; 3833 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty); 3834 Tmp = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, ST); 3835 V = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast( 3836 RegAddrLo, ST->getStructElementType(0))); 3837 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 0)); 3838 V = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast( 3839 RegAddrHi, ST->getStructElementType(1))); 3840 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 1)); 3841 3842 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, LTy); 3843 } 3844 3845 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 5. Set: 3846 // l->gp_offset = l->gp_offset + num_gp * 8 3847 // l->fp_offset = l->fp_offset + num_fp * 16. 3848 if (neededInt) { 3849 llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, neededInt * 8); 3850 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(gp_offset, Offset), 3851 gp_offset_p); 3852 } 3853 if (neededSSE) { 3854 llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, neededSSE * 16); 3855 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(fp_offset, Offset), 3856 fp_offset_p); 3857 } 3858 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 3859 3860 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in memory. 3861 3862 CGF.EmitBlock(InMemBlock); 3863 Address MemAddr = EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty); 3864 3865 // Return the appropriate result. 3866 3867 CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock); 3868 Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, MemAddr, InMemBlock, 3869 "vaarg.addr"); 3870 return ResAddr; 3871 } 3872 3873 Address X86_64ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3874 QualType Ty) const { 3875 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 3876 CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 3877 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), 3878 /*allowHigherAlign*/ false); 3879 } 3880 3881 ABIArgInfo 3882 WinX86_64ABIInfo::reclassifyHvaArgType(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, 3883 const ABIArgInfo ¤t) const { 3884 // Assumes vectorCall calling convention. 3885 const Type *Base = nullptr; 3886 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 3887 3888 if (!Ty->isBuiltinType() && !Ty->isVectorType() && 3889 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts) && FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 3890 FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 3891 return getDirectX86Hva(); 3892 } 3893 return current; 3894 } 3895 3896 ABIArgInfo WinX86_64ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, 3897 bool IsReturnType, bool IsVectorCall, 3898 bool IsRegCall) const { 3899 3900 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 3901 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 3902 3903 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 3904 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 3905 3906 TypeInfo Info = getContext().getTypeInfo(Ty); 3907 uint64_t Width = Info.Width; 3908 CharUnits Align = getContext().toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align); 3909 3910 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 3911 if (RT) { 3912 if (!IsReturnType) { 3913 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI())) 3914 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 3915 } 3916 3917 if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 3918 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 3919 3920 } 3921 3922 const Type *Base = nullptr; 3923 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 3924 // vectorcall adds the concept of a homogenous vector aggregate, similar to 3925 // other targets. 3926 if ((IsVectorCall || IsRegCall) && 3927 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) { 3928 if (IsRegCall) { 3929 if (FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 3930 FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 3931 if (IsReturnType || Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType()) 3932 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3933 return ABIArgInfo::getExpand(); 3934 } 3935 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false); 3936 } else if (IsVectorCall) { 3937 if (FreeSSERegs >= NumElts && 3938 (IsReturnType || Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType())) { 3939 FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 3940 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3941 } else if (IsReturnType) { 3942 return ABIArgInfo::getExpand(); 3943 } else if (!Ty->isBuiltinType() && !Ty->isVectorType()) { 3944 // HVAs are delayed and reclassified in the 2nd step. 3945 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false); 3946 } 3947 } 3948 } 3949 3950 if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 3951 // If the member pointer is represented by an LLVM int or ptr, pass it 3952 // directly. 3953 llvm::Type *LLTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 3954 if (LLTy->isPointerTy() || LLTy->isIntegerTy()) 3955 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3956 } 3957 3958 if (RT || Ty->isAnyComplexType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 3959 // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is 3960 // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference." 3961 if (Width > 64 || !llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width)) 3962 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 3963 3964 // Otherwise, coerce it to a small integer. 3965 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Width)); 3966 } 3967 3968 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 3969 switch (BT->getKind()) { 3970 case BuiltinType::Bool: 3971 // Bool type is always extended to the ABI, other builtin types are not 3972 // extended. 3973 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty); 3974 3975 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: 3976 // Mingw64 GCC uses the old 80 bit extended precision floating point 3977 // unit. It passes them indirectly through memory. 3978 if (IsMingw64) { 3979 const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat(); 3980 if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended()) 3981 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false); 3982 } 3983 break; 3984 3985 case BuiltinType::Int128: 3986 case BuiltinType::UInt128: 3987 // If it's a parameter type, the normal ABI rule is that arguments larger 3988 // than 8 bytes are passed indirectly. GCC follows it. We follow it too, 3989 // even though it isn't particularly efficient. 3990 if (!IsReturnType) 3991 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false); 3992 3993 // Mingw64 GCC returns i128 in XMM0. Coerce to v2i64 to handle that. 3994 // Clang matches them for compatibility. 3995 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect( 3996 llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()), 2)); 3997 3998 default: 3999 break; 4000 } 4001 } 4002 4003 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 4004 } 4005 4006 void WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, 4007 unsigned FreeSSERegs, 4008 bool IsVectorCall, 4009 bool IsRegCall) const { 4010 unsigned Count = 0; 4011 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 4012 // Vectorcall in x64 only permits the first 6 arguments to be passed 4013 // as XMM/YMM registers. 4014 if (Count < VectorcallMaxParamNumAsReg) 4015 I.info = classify(I.type, FreeSSERegs, false, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall); 4016 else { 4017 // Since these cannot be passed in registers, pretend no registers 4018 // are left. 4019 unsigned ZeroSSERegsAvail = 0; 4020 I.info = classify(I.type, /*FreeSSERegs=*/ZeroSSERegsAvail, false, 4021 IsVectorCall, IsRegCall); 4022 } 4023 ++Count; 4024 } 4025 4026 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 4027 I.info = reclassifyHvaArgType(I.type, FreeSSERegs, I.info); 4028 } 4029 } 4030 4031 void WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 4032 bool IsVectorCall = 4033 FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall; 4034 bool IsRegCall = FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall; 4035 4036 unsigned FreeSSERegs = 0; 4037 if (IsVectorCall) { 4038 // We can use up to 4 SSE return registers with vectorcall. 4039 FreeSSERegs = 4; 4040 } else if (IsRegCall) { 4041 // RegCall gives us 16 SSE registers. 4042 FreeSSERegs = 16; 4043 } 4044 4045 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 4046 FI.getReturnInfo() = classify(FI.getReturnType(), FreeSSERegs, true, 4047 IsVectorCall, IsRegCall); 4048 4049 if (IsVectorCall) { 4050 // We can use up to 6 SSE register parameters with vectorcall. 4051 FreeSSERegs = 6; 4052 } else if (IsRegCall) { 4053 // RegCall gives us 16 SSE registers, we can reuse the return registers. 4054 FreeSSERegs = 16; 4055 } 4056 4057 if (IsVectorCall) { 4058 computeVectorCallArgs(FI, FreeSSERegs, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall); 4059 } else { 4060 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 4061 I.info = classify(I.type, FreeSSERegs, false, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall); 4062 } 4063 4064 } 4065 4066 Address WinX86_64ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4067 QualType Ty) const { 4068 4069 bool IsIndirect = false; 4070 4071 // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is 4072 // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference." 4073 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 4074 uint64_t Width = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4075 IsIndirect = Width > 64 || !llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width); 4076 } 4077 4078 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, 4079 CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 4080 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), 4081 /*allowHigherAlign*/ false); 4082 } 4083 4084 // PowerPC-32 4085 namespace { 4086 /// PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo - The 32-bit PowerPC ELF (SVR4) ABI information. 4087 class PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 4088 bool IsSoftFloatABI; 4089 4090 CharUnits getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const; 4091 4092 public: 4093 PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool SoftFloatABI) 4094 : DefaultABIInfo(CGT), IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI) {} 4095 4096 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4097 QualType Ty) const override; 4098 }; 4099 4100 class PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 4101 public: 4102 PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool SoftFloatABI) 4103 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo(CGT, SoftFloatABI)) {} 4104 4105 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 4106 // This is recovered from gcc output. 4107 return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer 4108 } 4109 4110 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4111 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 4112 }; 4113 } 4114 4115 CharUnits PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo::getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const { 4116 // Complex types are passed just like their elements 4117 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) 4118 Ty = CTy->getElementType(); 4119 4120 if (Ty->isVectorType()) 4121 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 128 ? 16 4122 : 4); 4123 4124 // For single-element float/vector structs, we consider the whole type 4125 // to have the same alignment requirements as its single element. 4126 const Type *AlignTy = nullptr; 4127 if (const Type *EltType = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext())) { 4128 const BuiltinType *BT = EltType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 4129 if ((EltType->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(EltType) == 128) || 4130 (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint())) 4131 AlignTy = EltType; 4132 } 4133 4134 if (AlignTy) 4135 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(AlignTy->isVectorType() ? 16 : 4); 4136 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 4137 } 4138 4139 // TODO: this implementation is now likely redundant with 4140 // DefaultABIInfo::EmitVAArg. 4141 Address PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAList, 4142 QualType Ty) const { 4143 if (getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) { 4144 auto TI = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 4145 TI.second = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty); 4146 4147 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 4148 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAList, Ty, 4149 classifyArgumentType(Ty).isIndirect(), TI, SlotSize, 4150 /*AllowHigherAlign=*/true); 4151 } 4152 4153 const unsigned OverflowLimit = 8; 4154 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 4155 // TODO: Implement this. For now ignore. 4156 (void)CTy; 4157 return Address::invalid(); // FIXME? 4158 } 4159 4160 // struct __va_list_tag { 4161 // unsigned char gpr; 4162 // unsigned char fpr; 4163 // unsigned short reserved; 4164 // void *overflow_arg_area; 4165 // void *reg_save_area; 4166 // }; 4167 4168 bool isI64 = Ty->isIntegerType() && getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 64; 4169 bool isInt = 4170 Ty->isIntegerType() || Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isAggregateType(); 4171 bool isF64 = Ty->isFloatingType() && getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 64; 4172 4173 // All aggregates are passed indirectly? That doesn't seem consistent 4174 // with the argument-lowering code. 4175 bool isIndirect = Ty->isAggregateType(); 4176 4177 CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 4178 4179 // The calling convention either uses 1-2 GPRs or 1 FPR. 4180 Address NumRegsAddr = Address::invalid(); 4181 if (isInt || IsSoftFloatABI) { 4182 NumRegsAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 0, "gpr"); 4183 } else { 4184 NumRegsAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 1, "fpr"); 4185 } 4186 4187 llvm::Value *NumRegs = Builder.CreateLoad(NumRegsAddr, "numUsedRegs"); 4188 4189 // "Align" the register count when TY is i64. 4190 if (isI64 || (isF64 && IsSoftFloatABI)) { 4191 NumRegs = Builder.CreateAdd(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(1)); 4192 NumRegs = Builder.CreateAnd(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8((uint8_t) ~1U)); 4193 } 4194 4195 llvm::Value *CC = 4196 Builder.CreateICmpULT(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(OverflowLimit), "cond"); 4197 4198 llvm::BasicBlock *UsingRegs = CGF.createBasicBlock("using_regs"); 4199 llvm::BasicBlock *UsingOverflow = CGF.createBasicBlock("using_overflow"); 4200 llvm::BasicBlock *Cont = CGF.createBasicBlock("cont"); 4201 4202 Builder.CreateCondBr(CC, UsingRegs, UsingOverflow); 4203 4204 llvm::Type *DirectTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty); 4205 if (isIndirect) DirectTy = DirectTy->getPointerTo(0); 4206 4207 // Case 1: consume registers. 4208 Address RegAddr = Address::invalid(); 4209 { 4210 CGF.EmitBlock(UsingRegs); 4211 4212 Address RegSaveAreaPtr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 4); 4213 RegAddr = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(RegSaveAreaPtr), 4214 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 4215 assert(RegAddr.getElementType() == CGF.Int8Ty); 4216 4217 // Floating-point registers start after the general-purpose registers. 4218 if (!(isInt || IsSoftFloatABI)) { 4219 RegAddr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RegAddr, 4220 CharUnits::fromQuantity(32)); 4221 } 4222 4223 // Get the address of the saved value by scaling the number of 4224 // registers we've used by the number of 4225 CharUnits RegSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity((isInt || IsSoftFloatABI) ? 4 : 8); 4226 llvm::Value *RegOffset = 4227 Builder.CreateMul(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(RegSize.getQuantity())); 4228 RegAddr = Address(Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(CGF.Int8Ty, 4229 RegAddr.getPointer(), RegOffset), 4230 RegAddr.getAlignment().alignmentOfArrayElement(RegSize)); 4231 RegAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, DirectTy); 4232 4233 // Increase the used-register count. 4234 NumRegs = 4235 Builder.CreateAdd(NumRegs, 4236 Builder.getInt8((isI64 || (isF64 && IsSoftFloatABI)) ? 2 : 1)); 4237 Builder.CreateStore(NumRegs, NumRegsAddr); 4238 4239 CGF.EmitBranch(Cont); 4240 } 4241 4242 // Case 2: consume space in the overflow area. 4243 Address MemAddr = Address::invalid(); 4244 { 4245 CGF.EmitBlock(UsingOverflow); 4246 4247 Builder.CreateStore(Builder.getInt8(OverflowLimit), NumRegsAddr); 4248 4249 // Everything in the overflow area is rounded up to a size of at least 4. 4250 CharUnits OverflowAreaAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 4251 4252 CharUnits Size; 4253 if (!isIndirect) { 4254 auto TypeInfo = CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 4255 Size = TypeInfo.first.alignTo(OverflowAreaAlign); 4256 } else { 4257 Size = CGF.getPointerSize(); 4258 } 4259 4260 Address OverflowAreaAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 3); 4261 Address OverflowArea(Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowAreaAddr, "argp.cur"), 4262 OverflowAreaAlign); 4263 // Round up address of argument to alignment 4264 CharUnits Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty); 4265 if (Align > OverflowAreaAlign) { 4266 llvm::Value *Ptr = OverflowArea.getPointer(); 4267 OverflowArea = Address(emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, Ptr, Align), 4268 Align); 4269 } 4270 4271 MemAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OverflowArea, DirectTy); 4272 4273 // Increase the overflow area. 4274 OverflowArea = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(OverflowArea, Size); 4275 Builder.CreateStore(OverflowArea.getPointer(), OverflowAreaAddr); 4276 CGF.EmitBranch(Cont); 4277 } 4278 4279 CGF.EmitBlock(Cont); 4280 4281 // Merge the cases with a phi. 4282 Address Result = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, UsingRegs, MemAddr, UsingOverflow, 4283 "vaarg.addr"); 4284 4285 // Load the pointer if the argument was passed indirectly. 4286 if (isIndirect) { 4287 Result = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(Result, "aggr"), 4288 getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty)); 4289 } 4290 4291 return Result; 4292 } 4293 4294 bool 4295 PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4296 llvm::Value *Address) const { 4297 // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified 4298 // against gcc output. AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding. 4299 4300 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 4301 4302 llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty; 4303 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4); 4304 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8); 4305 llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 16); 4306 4307 // 0-31: r0-31, the 4-byte general-purpose registers 4308 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 31); 4309 4310 // 32-63: fp0-31, the 8-byte floating-point registers 4311 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 32, 63); 4312 4313 // 64-76 are various 4-byte special-purpose registers: 4314 // 64: mq 4315 // 65: lr 4316 // 66: ctr 4317 // 67: ap 4318 // 68-75 cr0-7 4319 // 76: xer 4320 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 64, 76); 4321 4322 // 77-108: v0-31, the 16-byte vector registers 4323 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 77, 108); 4324 4325 // 109: vrsave 4326 // 110: vscr 4327 // 111: spe_acc 4328 // 112: spefscr 4329 // 113: sfp 4330 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 109, 113); 4331 4332 return false; 4333 } 4334 4335 // PowerPC-64 4336 4337 namespace { 4338 /// PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo - The 64-bit PowerPC ELF (SVR4) ABI information. 4339 class PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 4340 public: 4341 enum ABIKind { 4342 ELFv1 = 0, 4343 ELFv2 4344 }; 4345 4346 private: 4347 static const unsigned GPRBits = 64; 4348 ABIKind Kind; 4349 bool HasQPX; 4350 bool IsSoftFloatABI; 4351 4352 // A vector of float or double will be promoted to <4 x f32> or <4 x f64> and 4353 // will be passed in a QPX register. 4354 bool IsQPXVectorTy(const Type *Ty) const { 4355 if (!HasQPX) 4356 return false; 4357 4358 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4359 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 4360 if (NumElements == 1) 4361 return false; 4362 4363 if (VT->getElementType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double)) { 4364 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 256) 4365 return true; 4366 } else if (VT->getElementType()-> 4367 isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) { 4368 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 128) 4369 return true; 4370 } 4371 } 4372 4373 return false; 4374 } 4375 4376 bool IsQPXVectorTy(QualType Ty) const { 4377 return IsQPXVectorTy(Ty.getTypePtr()); 4378 } 4379 4380 public: 4381 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind, bool HasQPX, 4382 bool SoftFloatABI) 4383 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind), HasQPX(HasQPX), 4384 IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI) {} 4385 4386 bool isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const; 4387 CharUnits getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const; 4388 4389 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 4390 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 4391 4392 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override; 4393 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 4394 uint64_t Members) const override; 4395 4396 // TODO: We can add more logic to computeInfo to improve performance. 4397 // Example: For aggregate arguments that fit in a register, we could 4398 // use getDirectInReg (as is done below for structs containing a single 4399 // floating-point value) to avoid pushing them to memory on function 4400 // entry. This would require changing the logic in PPCISelLowering 4401 // when lowering the parameters in the caller and args in the callee. 4402 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 4403 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 4404 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 4405 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 4406 // We rely on the default argument classification for the most part. 4407 // One exception: An aggregate containing a single floating-point 4408 // or vector item must be passed in a register if one is available. 4409 const Type *T = isSingleElementStruct(I.type, getContext()); 4410 if (T) { 4411 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 4412 if (IsQPXVectorTy(T) || 4413 (T->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(T) == 128) || 4414 (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint())) { 4415 QualType QT(T, 0); 4416 I.info = ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(CGT.ConvertType(QT)); 4417 continue; 4418 } 4419 } 4420 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 4421 } 4422 } 4423 4424 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4425 QualType Ty) const override; 4426 4427 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 4428 bool asReturnValue) const override { 4429 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 4430 } 4431 4432 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 4433 return false; 4434 } 4435 }; 4436 4437 class PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 4438 4439 public: 4440 PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, 4441 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind, bool HasQPX, 4442 bool SoftFloatABI) 4443 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo(CGT, Kind, HasQPX, 4444 SoftFloatABI)) {} 4445 4446 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 4447 // This is recovered from gcc output. 4448 return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer 4449 } 4450 4451 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4452 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 4453 }; 4454 4455 class PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo : public DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo { 4456 public: 4457 PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT) {} 4458 4459 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 4460 // This is recovered from gcc output. 4461 return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer 4462 } 4463 4464 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4465 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 4466 }; 4467 4468 } 4469 4470 // Return true if the ABI requires Ty to be passed sign- or zero- 4471 // extended to 64 bits. 4472 bool 4473 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const { 4474 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 4475 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 4476 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 4477 4478 // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI. 4479 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) 4480 return true; 4481 4482 // In addition to the usual promotable integer types, we also need to 4483 // extend all 32-bit types, since the ABI requires promotion to 64 bits. 4484 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 4485 switch (BT->getKind()) { 4486 case BuiltinType::Int: 4487 case BuiltinType::UInt: 4488 return true; 4489 default: 4490 break; 4491 } 4492 4493 return false; 4494 } 4495 4496 /// isAlignedParamType - Determine whether a type requires 16-byte or 4497 /// higher alignment in the parameter area. Always returns at least 8. 4498 CharUnits PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const { 4499 // Complex types are passed just like their elements. 4500 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) 4501 Ty = CTy->getElementType(); 4502 4503 // Only vector types of size 16 bytes need alignment (larger types are 4504 // passed via reference, smaller types are not aligned). 4505 if (IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) { 4506 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) > 128) 4507 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32); 4508 4509 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 4510 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 4511 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 128 ? 16 : 8); 4512 } 4513 4514 // For single-element float/vector structs, we consider the whole type 4515 // to have the same alignment requirements as its single element. 4516 const Type *AlignAsType = nullptr; 4517 const Type *EltType = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()); 4518 if (EltType) { 4519 const BuiltinType *BT = EltType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 4520 if (IsQPXVectorTy(EltType) || (EltType->isVectorType() && 4521 getContext().getTypeSize(EltType) == 128) || 4522 (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint())) 4523 AlignAsType = EltType; 4524 } 4525 4526 // Likewise for ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates. 4527 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4528 uint64_t Members = 0; 4529 if (!AlignAsType && Kind == ELFv2 && 4530 isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) 4531 AlignAsType = Base; 4532 4533 // With special case aggregates, only vector base types need alignment. 4534 if (AlignAsType && IsQPXVectorTy(AlignAsType)) { 4535 if (getContext().getTypeSize(AlignAsType) > 128) 4536 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32); 4537 4538 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 4539 } else if (AlignAsType) { 4540 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(AlignAsType->isVectorType() ? 16 : 8); 4541 } 4542 4543 // Otherwise, we only need alignment for any aggregate type that 4544 // has an alignment requirement of >= 16 bytes. 4545 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) >= 128) { 4546 if (HasQPX && getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) >= 256) 4547 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32); 4548 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 4549 } 4550 4551 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 4552 } 4553 4554 /// isHomogeneousAggregate - Return true if a type is an ELFv2 homogeneous 4555 /// aggregate. Base is set to the base element type, and Members is set 4556 /// to the number of base elements. 4557 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregate(QualType Ty, const Type *&Base, 4558 uint64_t &Members) const { 4559 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) { 4560 uint64_t NElements = AT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 4561 if (NElements == 0) 4562 return false; 4563 if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(AT->getElementType(), Base, Members)) 4564 return false; 4565 Members *= NElements; 4566 } else if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 4567 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 4568 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 4569 return false; 4570 4571 Members = 0; 4572 4573 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 4574 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 4575 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 4576 // Ignore empty records. 4577 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), I.getType(), true)) 4578 continue; 4579 4580 uint64_t FldMembers; 4581 if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(I.getType(), Base, FldMembers)) 4582 return false; 4583 4584 Members += FldMembers; 4585 } 4586 } 4587 4588 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 4589 // Ignore (non-zero arrays of) empty records. 4590 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 4591 while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = 4592 getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) { 4593 if (AT->getSize().getZExtValue() == 0) 4594 return false; 4595 FT = AT->getElementType(); 4596 } 4597 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), FT, true)) 4598 continue; 4599 4600 // For compatibility with GCC, ignore empty bitfields in C++ mode. 4601 if (getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4602 FD->isZeroLengthBitField(getContext())) 4603 continue; 4604 4605 uint64_t FldMembers; 4606 if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(FD->getType(), Base, FldMembers)) 4607 return false; 4608 4609 Members = (RD->isUnion() ? 4610 std::max(Members, FldMembers) : Members + FldMembers); 4611 } 4612 4613 if (!Base) 4614 return false; 4615 4616 // Ensure there is no padding. 4617 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) * Members != 4618 getContext().getTypeSize(Ty)) 4619 return false; 4620 } else { 4621 Members = 1; 4622 if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 4623 Members = 2; 4624 Ty = CT->getElementType(); 4625 } 4626 4627 // Most ABIs only support float, double, and some vector type widths. 4628 if (!isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(Ty)) 4629 return false; 4630 4631 // The base type must be the same for all members. Types that 4632 // agree in both total size and mode (float vs. vector) are 4633 // treated as being equivalent here. 4634 const Type *TyPtr = Ty.getTypePtr(); 4635 if (!Base) { 4636 Base = TyPtr; 4637 // If it's a non-power-of-2 vector, its size is already a power-of-2, 4638 // so make sure to widen it explicitly. 4639 if (const VectorType *VT = Base->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4640 QualType EltTy = VT->getElementType(); 4641 unsigned NumElements = 4642 getContext().getTypeSize(VT) / getContext().getTypeSize(EltTy); 4643 Base = getContext() 4644 .getVectorType(EltTy, NumElements, VT->getVectorKind()) 4645 .getTypePtr(); 4646 } 4647 } 4648 4649 if (Base->isVectorType() != TyPtr->isVectorType() || 4650 getContext().getTypeSize(Base) != getContext().getTypeSize(TyPtr)) 4651 return false; 4652 } 4653 return Members > 0 && isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(Base, Members); 4654 } 4655 4656 bool PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 4657 // Homogeneous aggregates for ELFv2 must have base types of float, 4658 // double, long double, or 128-bit vectors. 4659 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 4660 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 4661 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double || 4662 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble || 4663 (getContext().getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type() && 4664 (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128))) { 4665 if (IsSoftFloatABI) 4666 return false; 4667 return true; 4668 } 4669 } 4670 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4671 if (getContext().getTypeSize(VT) == 128 || IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) 4672 return true; 4673 } 4674 return false; 4675 } 4676 4677 bool PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough( 4678 const Type *Base, uint64_t Members) const { 4679 // Vector and fp128 types require one register, other floating point types 4680 // require one or two registers depending on their size. 4681 uint32_t NumRegs = 4682 ((getContext().getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type() && 4683 Base->isFloat128Type()) || 4684 Base->isVectorType()) ? 1 4685 : (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) + 63) / 64; 4686 4687 // Homogeneous Aggregates may occupy at most 8 registers. 4688 return Members * NumRegs <= 8; 4689 } 4690 4691 ABIArgInfo 4692 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 4693 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 4694 4695 if (Ty->isAnyComplexType()) 4696 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 4697 4698 // Non-Altivec vector types are passed in GPRs (smaller than 16 bytes) 4699 // or via reference (larger than 16 bytes). 4700 if (Ty->isVectorType() && !IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) { 4701 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4702 if (Size > 128) 4703 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 4704 else if (Size < 128) { 4705 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size); 4706 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4707 } 4708 } 4709 4710 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 4711 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 4712 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 4713 4714 uint64_t ABIAlign = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty).getQuantity(); 4715 uint64_t TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty).getQuantity(); 4716 4717 // ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates are passed as array types. 4718 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4719 uint64_t Members = 0; 4720 if (Kind == ELFv2 && 4721 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 4722 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)); 4723 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Members); 4724 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4725 } 4726 4727 // If an aggregate may end up fully in registers, we do not 4728 // use the ByVal method, but pass the aggregate as array. 4729 // This is usually beneficial since we avoid forcing the 4730 // back-end to store the argument to memory. 4731 uint64_t Bits = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4732 if (Bits > 0 && Bits <= 8 * GPRBits) { 4733 llvm::Type *CoerceTy; 4734 4735 // Types up to 8 bytes are passed as integer type (which will be 4736 // properly aligned in the argument save area doubleword). 4737 if (Bits <= GPRBits) 4738 CoerceTy = 4739 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), llvm::alignTo(Bits, 8)); 4740 // Larger types are passed as arrays, with the base type selected 4741 // according to the required alignment in the save area. 4742 else { 4743 uint64_t RegBits = ABIAlign * 8; 4744 uint64_t NumRegs = llvm::alignTo(Bits, RegBits) / RegBits; 4745 llvm::Type *RegTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), RegBits); 4746 CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(RegTy, NumRegs); 4747 } 4748 4749 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4750 } 4751 4752 // All other aggregates are passed ByVal. 4753 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(ABIAlign), 4754 /*ByVal=*/true, 4755 /*Realign=*/TyAlign > ABIAlign); 4756 } 4757 4758 return (isPromotableTypeForABI(Ty) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty) 4759 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4760 } 4761 4762 ABIArgInfo 4763 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 4764 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 4765 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4766 4767 if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 4768 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 4769 4770 // Non-Altivec vector types are returned in GPRs (smaller than 16 bytes) 4771 // or via reference (larger than 16 bytes). 4772 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && !IsQPXVectorTy(RetTy)) { 4773 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 4774 if (Size > 128) 4775 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 4776 else if (Size < 128) { 4777 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size); 4778 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4779 } 4780 } 4781 4782 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 4783 // ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates are returned as array types. 4784 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4785 uint64_t Members = 0; 4786 if (Kind == ELFv2 && 4787 isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) { 4788 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)); 4789 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Members); 4790 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4791 } 4792 4793 // ELFv2 small aggregates are returned in up to two registers. 4794 uint64_t Bits = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 4795 if (Kind == ELFv2 && Bits <= 2 * GPRBits) { 4796 if (Bits == 0) 4797 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4798 4799 llvm::Type *CoerceTy; 4800 if (Bits > GPRBits) { 4801 CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), GPRBits); 4802 CoerceTy = llvm::StructType::get(CoerceTy, CoerceTy); 4803 } else 4804 CoerceTy = 4805 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), llvm::alignTo(Bits, 8)); 4806 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4807 } 4808 4809 // All other aggregates are returned indirectly. 4810 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 4811 } 4812 4813 return (isPromotableTypeForABI(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy) 4814 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4815 } 4816 4817 // Based on ARMABIInfo::EmitVAArg, adjusted for 64-bit machine. 4818 Address PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4819 QualType Ty) const { 4820 auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 4821 TypeInfo.second = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty); 4822 4823 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 4824 4825 // If we have a complex type and the base type is smaller than 8 bytes, 4826 // the ABI calls for the real and imaginary parts to be right-adjusted 4827 // in separate doublewords. However, Clang expects us to produce a 4828 // pointer to a structure with the two parts packed tightly. So generate 4829 // loads of the real and imaginary parts relative to the va_list pointer, 4830 // and store them to a temporary structure. 4831 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 4832 CharUnits EltSize = TypeInfo.first / 2; 4833 if (EltSize < SlotSize) { 4834 Address Addr = emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, CGF.Int8Ty, 4835 SlotSize * 2, SlotSize, 4836 SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true); 4837 4838 Address RealAddr = Addr; 4839 Address ImagAddr = RealAddr; 4840 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian()) { 4841 RealAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RealAddr, 4842 SlotSize - EltSize); 4843 ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(ImagAddr, 4844 2 * SlotSize - EltSize); 4845 } else { 4846 ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RealAddr, SlotSize); 4847 } 4848 4849 llvm::Type *EltTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(CTy->getElementType()); 4850 RealAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RealAddr, EltTy); 4851 ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(ImagAddr, EltTy); 4852 llvm::Value *Real = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RealAddr, ".vareal"); 4853 llvm::Value *Imag = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ImagAddr, ".vaimag"); 4854 4855 Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty, "vacplx"); 4856 CGF.EmitStoreOfComplex({Real, Imag}, CGF.MakeAddrLValue(Temp, Ty), 4857 /*init*/ true); 4858 return Temp; 4859 } 4860 } 4861 4862 // Otherwise, just use the general rule. 4863 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false, 4864 TypeInfo, SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true); 4865 } 4866 4867 static bool 4868 PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4869 llvm::Value *Address) { 4870 // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified 4871 // against gcc output. AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding. 4872 4873 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 4874 4875 llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty; 4876 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4); 4877 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8); 4878 llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 16); 4879 4880 // 0-31: r0-31, the 8-byte general-purpose registers 4881 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 31); 4882 4883 // 32-63: fp0-31, the 8-byte floating-point registers 4884 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 32, 63); 4885 4886 // 64-67 are various 8-byte special-purpose registers: 4887 // 64: mq 4888 // 65: lr 4889 // 66: ctr 4890 // 67: ap 4891 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 64, 67); 4892 4893 // 68-76 are various 4-byte special-purpose registers: 4894 // 68-75 cr0-7 4895 // 76: xer 4896 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 68, 76); 4897 4898 // 77-108: v0-31, the 16-byte vector registers 4899 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 77, 108); 4900 4901 // 109: vrsave 4902 // 110: vscr 4903 // 111: spe_acc 4904 // 112: spefscr 4905 // 113: sfp 4906 // 114: tfhar 4907 // 115: tfiar 4908 // 116: texasr 4909 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 109, 116); 4910 4911 return false; 4912 } 4913 4914 bool 4915 PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable( 4916 CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4917 llvm::Value *Address) const { 4918 4919 return PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address); 4920 } 4921 4922 bool 4923 PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4924 llvm::Value *Address) const { 4925 4926 return PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address); 4927 } 4928 4929 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 4930 // AArch64 ABI Implementation 4931 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 4932 4933 namespace { 4934 4935 class AArch64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 4936 public: 4937 enum ABIKind { 4938 AAPCS = 0, 4939 DarwinPCS, 4940 Win64 4941 }; 4942 4943 private: 4944 ABIKind Kind; 4945 4946 public: 4947 AArch64ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind) 4948 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind) {} 4949 4950 private: 4951 ABIKind getABIKind() const { return Kind; } 4952 bool isDarwinPCS() const { return Kind == DarwinPCS; } 4953 4954 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 4955 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 4956 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override; 4957 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 4958 uint64_t Members) const override; 4959 4960 bool isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 4961 4962 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 4963 if (!::classifyReturnType(getCXXABI(), FI, *this)) 4964 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 4965 4966 for (auto &it : FI.arguments()) 4967 it.info = classifyArgumentType(it.type); 4968 } 4969 4970 Address EmitDarwinVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 4971 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const; 4972 4973 Address EmitAAPCSVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 4974 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const; 4975 4976 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4977 QualType Ty) const override { 4978 return Kind == Win64 ? EmitMSVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty) 4979 : isDarwinPCS() ? EmitDarwinVAArg(VAListAddr, Ty, CGF) 4980 : EmitAAPCSVAArg(VAListAddr, Ty, CGF); 4981 } 4982 4983 Address EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4984 QualType Ty) const override; 4985 4986 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 4987 bool asReturnValue) const override { 4988 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 4989 } 4990 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 4991 return true; 4992 } 4993 4994 bool isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, llvm::Type *eltTy, 4995 unsigned elts) const override; 4996 }; 4997 4998 class AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 4999 public: 5000 AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind) 5001 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new AArch64ABIInfo(CGT, Kind)) {} 5002 5003 StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override { 5004 return "mov\tfp, fp\t\t// marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue"; 5005 } 5006 5007 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 5008 return 31; 5009 } 5010 5011 bool doesReturnSlotInterfereWithArgs() const override { return false; } 5012 5013 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 5014 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 5015 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 5016 if (!FD) 5017 return; 5018 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 5019 5020 auto Kind = CGM.getCodeGenOpts().getSignReturnAddress(); 5021 if (Kind != CodeGenOptions::SignReturnAddressScope::None) { 5022 Fn->addFnAttr("sign-return-address", 5023 Kind == CodeGenOptions::SignReturnAddressScope::All 5024 ? "all" 5025 : "non-leaf"); 5026 5027 auto Key = CGM.getCodeGenOpts().getSignReturnAddressKey(); 5028 Fn->addFnAttr("sign-return-address-key", 5029 Key == CodeGenOptions::SignReturnAddressKeyValue::AKey 5030 ? "a_key" 5031 : "b_key"); 5032 } 5033 5034 if (CGM.getCodeGenOpts().BranchTargetEnforcement) 5035 Fn->addFnAttr("branch-target-enforcement"); 5036 } 5037 }; 5038 5039 class WindowsAArch64TargetCodeGenInfo : public AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo { 5040 public: 5041 WindowsAArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind K) 5042 : AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, K) {} 5043 5044 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 5045 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 5046 5047 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 5048 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 5049 Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:" + qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib); 5050 } 5051 5052 void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, llvm::StringRef Value, 5053 llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override { 5054 Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\""; 5055 } 5056 }; 5057 5058 void WindowsAArch64TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 5059 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 5060 AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 5061 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 5062 return; 5063 addStackProbeTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 5064 } 5065 } 5066 5067 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 5068 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 5069 5070 // Handle illegal vector types here. 5071 if (isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 5072 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 5073 // Android promotes <2 x i8> to i16, not i32 5074 if (isAndroid() && (Size <= 16)) { 5075 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()); 5076 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5077 } 5078 if (Size <= 32) { 5079 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5080 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5081 } 5082 if (Size == 64) { 5083 llvm::Type *ResType = 5084 llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 2); 5085 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5086 } 5087 if (Size == 128) { 5088 llvm::Type *ResType = 5089 llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 4); 5090 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5091 } 5092 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 5093 } 5094 5095 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 5096 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 5097 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 5098 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 5099 5100 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() && isDarwinPCS() 5101 ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty) 5102 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 5103 } 5104 5105 // Structures with either a non-trivial destructor or a non-trivial 5106 // copy constructor are always indirect. 5107 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) { 5108 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/RAA == 5109 CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 5110 } 5111 5112 // Empty records are always ignored on Darwin, but actually passed in C++ mode 5113 // elsewhere for GNU compatibility. 5114 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 5115 bool IsEmpty = isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true); 5116 if (IsEmpty || Size == 0) { 5117 if (!getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || isDarwinPCS()) 5118 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5119 5120 // GNU C mode. The only argument that gets ignored is an empty one with size 5121 // 0. 5122 if (IsEmpty && Size == 0) 5123 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5124 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 5125 } 5126 5127 // Homogeneous Floating-point Aggregates (HFAs) need to be expanded. 5128 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5129 uint64_t Members = 0; 5130 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 5131 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect( 5132 llvm::ArrayType::get(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)), Members)); 5133 } 5134 5135 // Aggregates <= 16 bytes are passed directly in registers or on the stack. 5136 if (Size <= 128) { 5137 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 16 bytes to an integer array of 5138 // same size and alignment. 5139 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 5140 return coerceToIntArray(Ty, getContext(), getVMContext()); 5141 } 5142 unsigned Alignment; 5143 if (Kind == AArch64ABIInfo::AAPCS) { 5144 Alignment = getContext().getTypeUnadjustedAlign(Ty); 5145 Alignment = Alignment < 128 ? 64 : 128; 5146 } else { 5147 Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty); 5148 } 5149 Size = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64); // round up to multiple of 8 bytes 5150 5151 // We use a pair of i64 for 16-byte aggregate with 8-byte alignment. 5152 // For aggregates with 16-byte alignment, we use i128. 5153 if (Alignment < 128 && Size == 128) { 5154 llvm::Type *BaseTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()); 5155 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Size / 64)); 5156 } 5157 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size)); 5158 } 5159 5160 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 5161 } 5162 5163 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 5164 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 5165 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5166 5167 // Large vector types should be returned via memory. 5168 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 128) 5169 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 5170 5171 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 5172 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 5173 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 5174 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 5175 5176 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() && isDarwinPCS() 5177 ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy) 5178 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 5179 } 5180 5181 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 5182 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true) || Size == 0) 5183 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5184 5185 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5186 uint64_t Members = 0; 5187 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) 5188 // Homogeneous Floating-point Aggregates (HFAs) are returned directly. 5189 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 5190 5191 // Aggregates <= 16 bytes are returned directly in registers or on the stack. 5192 if (Size <= 128) { 5193 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 16 bytes to an integer array of 5194 // same size and alignment. 5195 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 5196 return coerceToIntArray(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext()); 5197 } 5198 unsigned Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(RetTy); 5199 Size = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64); // round up to multiple of 8 bytes 5200 5201 // We use a pair of i64 for 16-byte aggregate with 8-byte alignment. 5202 // For aggregates with 16-byte alignment, we use i128. 5203 if (Alignment < 128 && Size == 128) { 5204 llvm::Type *BaseTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()); 5205 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Size / 64)); 5206 } 5207 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size)); 5208 } 5209 5210 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 5211 } 5212 5213 /// isIllegalVectorType - check whether the vector type is legal for AArch64. 5214 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 5215 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 5216 // Check whether VT is legal. 5217 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 5218 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 5219 // NumElements should be power of 2. 5220 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements)) 5221 return true; 5222 return Size != 64 && (Size != 128 || NumElements == 1); 5223 } 5224 return false; 5225 } 5226 5227 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 5228 llvm::Type *eltTy, 5229 unsigned elts) const { 5230 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(elts)) 5231 return false; 5232 if (totalSize.getQuantity() != 8 && 5233 (totalSize.getQuantity() != 16 || elts == 1)) 5234 return false; 5235 return true; 5236 } 5237 5238 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 5239 // Homogeneous aggregates for AAPCS64 must have base types of a floating 5240 // point type or a short-vector type. This is the same as the 32-bit ABI, 5241 // but with the difference that any floating-point type is allowed, 5242 // including __fp16. 5243 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 5244 if (BT->isFloatingPoint()) 5245 return true; 5246 } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 5247 unsigned VecSize = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 5248 if (VecSize == 64 || VecSize == 128) 5249 return true; 5250 } 5251 return false; 5252 } 5253 5254 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base, 5255 uint64_t Members) const { 5256 return Members <= 4; 5257 } 5258 5259 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitAAPCSVAArg(Address VAListAddr, 5260 QualType Ty, 5261 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const { 5262 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty); 5263 bool IsIndirect = AI.isIndirect(); 5264 5265 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty); 5266 if (IsIndirect) 5267 BaseTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(BaseTy); 5268 else if (AI.getCoerceToType()) 5269 BaseTy = AI.getCoerceToType(); 5270 5271 unsigned NumRegs = 1; 5272 if (llvm::ArrayType *ArrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(BaseTy)) { 5273 BaseTy = ArrTy->getElementType(); 5274 NumRegs = ArrTy->getNumElements(); 5275 } 5276 bool IsFPR = BaseTy->isFloatingPointTy() || BaseTy->isVectorTy(); 5277 5278 // The AArch64 va_list type and handling is specified in the Procedure Call 5279 // Standard, section B.4: 5280 // 5281 // struct { 5282 // void *__stack; 5283 // void *__gr_top; 5284 // void *__vr_top; 5285 // int __gr_offs; 5286 // int __vr_offs; 5287 // }; 5288 5289 llvm::BasicBlock *MaybeRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.maybe_reg"); 5290 llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg"); 5291 llvm::BasicBlock *OnStackBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.on_stack"); 5292 llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end"); 5293 5294 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 5295 CharUnits TyAlign = TyInfo.second; 5296 5297 Address reg_offs_p = Address::invalid(); 5298 llvm::Value *reg_offs = nullptr; 5299 int reg_top_index; 5300 int RegSize = IsIndirect ? 8 : TyInfo.first.getQuantity(); 5301 if (!IsFPR) { 5302 // 3 is the field number of __gr_offs 5303 reg_offs_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, "gr_offs_p"); 5304 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_offs_p, "gr_offs"); 5305 reg_top_index = 1; // field number for __gr_top 5306 RegSize = llvm::alignTo(RegSize, 8); 5307 } else { 5308 // 4 is the field number of __vr_offs. 5309 reg_offs_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 4, "vr_offs_p"); 5310 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_offs_p, "vr_offs"); 5311 reg_top_index = 2; // field number for __vr_top 5312 RegSize = 16 * NumRegs; 5313 } 5314 5315 //======================================= 5316 // Find out where argument was passed 5317 //======================================= 5318 5319 // If reg_offs >= 0 we're already using the stack for this type of 5320 // argument. We don't want to keep updating reg_offs (in case it overflows, 5321 // though anyone passing 2GB of arguments, each at most 16 bytes, deserves 5322 // whatever they get). 5323 llvm::Value *UsingStack = nullptr; 5324 UsingStack = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSGE( 5325 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 0)); 5326 5327 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(UsingStack, OnStackBlock, MaybeRegBlock); 5328 5329 // Otherwise, at least some kind of argument could go in these registers, the 5330 // question is whether this particular type is too big. 5331 CGF.EmitBlock(MaybeRegBlock); 5332 5333 // Integer arguments may need to correct register alignment (for example a 5334 // "struct { __int128 a; };" gets passed in x_2N, x_{2N+1}). In this case we 5335 // align __gr_offs to calculate the potential address. 5336 if (!IsFPR && !IsIndirect && TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) { 5337 int Align = TyAlign.getQuantity(); 5338 5339 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd( 5340 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, Align - 1), 5341 "align_regoffs"); 5342 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd( 5343 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, -Align), 5344 "aligned_regoffs"); 5345 } 5346 5347 // Update the gr_offs/vr_offs pointer for next call to va_arg on this va_list. 5348 // The fact that this is done unconditionally reflects the fact that 5349 // allocating an argument to the stack also uses up all the remaining 5350 // registers of the appropriate kind. 5351 llvm::Value *NewOffset = nullptr; 5352 NewOffset = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd( 5353 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, RegSize), "new_reg_offs"); 5354 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOffset, reg_offs_p); 5355 5356 // Now we're in a position to decide whether this argument really was in 5357 // registers or not. 5358 llvm::Value *InRegs = nullptr; 5359 InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSLE( 5360 NewOffset, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 0), "inreg"); 5361 5362 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, OnStackBlock); 5363 5364 //======================================= 5365 // Argument was in registers 5366 //======================================= 5367 5368 // Now we emit the code for if the argument was originally passed in 5369 // registers. First start the appropriate block: 5370 CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock); 5371 5372 llvm::Value *reg_top = nullptr; 5373 Address reg_top_p = 5374 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, reg_top_index, "reg_top_p"); 5375 reg_top = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_top_p, "reg_top"); 5376 Address BaseAddr(CGF.Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(reg_top, reg_offs), 5377 CharUnits::fromQuantity(IsFPR ? 16 : 8)); 5378 Address RegAddr = Address::invalid(); 5379 llvm::Type *MemTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 5380 5381 if (IsIndirect) { 5382 // If it's been passed indirectly (actually a struct), whatever we find from 5383 // stored registers or on the stack will actually be a struct **. 5384 MemTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(MemTy); 5385 } 5386 5387 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5388 uint64_t NumMembers = 0; 5389 bool IsHFA = isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumMembers); 5390 if (IsHFA && NumMembers > 1) { 5391 // Homogeneous aggregates passed in registers will have their elements split 5392 // and stored 16-bytes apart regardless of size (they're notionally in qN, 5393 // qN+1, ...). We reload and store into a temporary local variable 5394 // contiguously. 5395 assert(!IsIndirect && "Homogeneous aggregates should be passed directly"); 5396 auto BaseTyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(QualType(Base, 0)); 5397 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)); 5398 llvm::Type *HFATy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, NumMembers); 5399 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateTempAlloca(HFATy, 5400 std::max(TyAlign, BaseTyInfo.second)); 5401 5402 // On big-endian platforms, the value will be right-aligned in its slot. 5403 int Offset = 0; 5404 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && 5405 BaseTyInfo.first.getQuantity() < 16) 5406 Offset = 16 - BaseTyInfo.first.getQuantity(); 5407 5408 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumMembers; ++i) { 5409 CharUnits BaseOffset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16 * i + Offset); 5410 Address LoadAddr = 5411 CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(BaseAddr, BaseOffset); 5412 LoadAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(LoadAddr, BaseTy); 5413 5414 Address StoreAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstArrayGEP(Tmp, i); 5415 5416 llvm::Value *Elem = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(LoadAddr); 5417 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(Elem, StoreAddr); 5418 } 5419 5420 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, MemTy); 5421 } else { 5422 // Otherwise the object is contiguous in memory. 5423 5424 // It might be right-aligned in its slot. 5425 CharUnits SlotSize = BaseAddr.getAlignment(); 5426 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && !IsIndirect && 5427 (IsHFA || !isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) && 5428 TyInfo.first < SlotSize) { 5429 CharUnits Offset = SlotSize - TyInfo.first; 5430 BaseAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(BaseAddr, Offset); 5431 } 5432 5433 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(BaseAddr, MemTy); 5434 } 5435 5436 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 5437 5438 //======================================= 5439 // Argument was on the stack 5440 //======================================= 5441 CGF.EmitBlock(OnStackBlock); 5442 5443 Address stack_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 0, "stack_p"); 5444 llvm::Value *OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(stack_p, "stack"); 5445 5446 // Again, stack arguments may need realignment. In this case both integer and 5447 // floating-point ones might be affected. 5448 if (!IsIndirect && TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) { 5449 int Align = TyAlign.getQuantity(); 5450 5451 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(OnStackPtr, CGF.Int64Ty); 5452 5453 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd( 5454 OnStackPtr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, Align - 1), 5455 "align_stack"); 5456 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd( 5457 OnStackPtr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, -Align), 5458 "align_stack"); 5459 5460 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(OnStackPtr, CGF.Int8PtrTy); 5461 } 5462 Address OnStackAddr(OnStackPtr, 5463 std::max(CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), TyAlign)); 5464 5465 // All stack slots are multiples of 8 bytes. 5466 CharUnits StackSlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 5467 CharUnits StackSize; 5468 if (IsIndirect) 5469 StackSize = StackSlotSize; 5470 else 5471 StackSize = TyInfo.first.alignTo(StackSlotSize); 5472 5473 llvm::Value *StackSizeC = CGF.Builder.getSize(StackSize); 5474 llvm::Value *NewStack = 5475 CGF.Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(OnStackPtr, StackSizeC, "new_stack"); 5476 5477 // Write the new value of __stack for the next call to va_arg 5478 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewStack, stack_p); 5479 5480 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && !isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && 5481 TyInfo.first < StackSlotSize) { 5482 CharUnits Offset = StackSlotSize - TyInfo.first; 5483 OnStackAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(OnStackAddr, Offset); 5484 } 5485 5486 OnStackAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OnStackAddr, MemTy); 5487 5488 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 5489 5490 //======================================= 5491 // Tidy up 5492 //======================================= 5493 CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock); 5494 5495 Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, 5496 OnStackAddr, OnStackBlock, "vaargs.addr"); 5497 5498 if (IsIndirect) 5499 return Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ResAddr, "vaarg.addr"), 5500 TyInfo.second); 5501 5502 return ResAddr; 5503 } 5504 5505 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitDarwinVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 5506 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const { 5507 // The backend's lowering doesn't support va_arg for aggregates or 5508 // illegal vector types. Lower VAArg here for these cases and use 5509 // the LLVM va_arg instruction for everything else. 5510 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) 5511 return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 5512 5513 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 5514 5515 // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes. 5516 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) { 5517 Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "ap.cur"), SlotSize); 5518 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty)); 5519 return Addr; 5520 } 5521 5522 // The size of the actual thing passed, which might end up just 5523 // being a pointer for indirect types. 5524 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 5525 5526 // Arguments bigger than 16 bytes which aren't homogeneous 5527 // aggregates should be passed indirectly. 5528 bool IsIndirect = false; 5529 if (TyInfo.first.getQuantity() > 16) { 5530 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5531 uint64_t Members = 0; 5532 IsIndirect = !isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members); 5533 } 5534 5535 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, 5536 TyInfo, SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 5537 } 5538 5539 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 5540 QualType Ty) const { 5541 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 5542 CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 5543 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), 5544 /*allowHigherAlign*/ false); 5545 } 5546 5547 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 5548 // ARM ABI Implementation 5549 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 5550 5551 namespace { 5552 5553 class ARMABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 5554 public: 5555 enum ABIKind { 5556 APCS = 0, 5557 AAPCS = 1, 5558 AAPCS_VFP = 2, 5559 AAPCS16_VFP = 3, 5560 }; 5561 5562 private: 5563 ABIKind Kind; 5564 5565 public: 5566 ARMABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind _Kind) 5567 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(_Kind) { 5568 setCCs(); 5569 } 5570 5571 bool isEABI() const { 5572 switch (getTarget().getTriple().getEnvironment()) { 5573 case llvm::Triple::Android: 5574 case llvm::Triple::EABI: 5575 case llvm::Triple::EABIHF: 5576 case llvm::Triple::GNUEABI: 5577 case llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF: 5578 case llvm::Triple::MuslEABI: 5579 case llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF: 5580 return true; 5581 default: 5582 return false; 5583 } 5584 } 5585 5586 bool isEABIHF() const { 5587 switch (getTarget().getTriple().getEnvironment()) { 5588 case llvm::Triple::EABIHF: 5589 case llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF: 5590 case llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF: 5591 return true; 5592 default: 5593 return false; 5594 } 5595 } 5596 5597 ABIKind getABIKind() const { return Kind; } 5598 5599 private: 5600 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic) const; 5601 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic) const; 5602 ABIArgInfo classifyHomogeneousAggregate(QualType Ty, const Type *Base, 5603 uint64_t Members) const; 5604 ABIArgInfo coerceIllegalVector(QualType Ty) const; 5605 bool isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 5606 5607 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override; 5608 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 5609 uint64_t Members) const override; 5610 5611 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 5612 5613 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 5614 QualType Ty) const override; 5615 5616 llvm::CallingConv::ID getLLVMDefaultCC() const; 5617 llvm::CallingConv::ID getABIDefaultCC() const; 5618 void setCCs(); 5619 5620 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 5621 bool asReturnValue) const override { 5622 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 5623 } 5624 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 5625 return true; 5626 } 5627 bool isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, llvm::Type *eltTy, 5628 unsigned elts) const override; 5629 }; 5630 5631 class ARMTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 5632 public: 5633 ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ARMABIInfo::ABIKind K) 5634 :TargetCodeGenInfo(new ARMABIInfo(CGT, K)) {} 5635 5636 const ARMABIInfo &getABIInfo() const { 5637 return static_cast<const ARMABIInfo&>(TargetCodeGenInfo::getABIInfo()); 5638 } 5639 5640 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 5641 return 13; 5642 } 5643 5644 StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override { 5645 return "mov\tr7, r7\t\t// marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue"; 5646 } 5647 5648 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 5649 llvm::Value *Address) const override { 5650 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4); 5651 5652 // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers. 5653 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 15); 5654 return false; 5655 } 5656 5657 unsigned getSizeOfUnwindException() const override { 5658 if (getABIInfo().isEABI()) return 88; 5659 return TargetCodeGenInfo::getSizeOfUnwindException(); 5660 } 5661 5662 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 5663 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 5664 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 5665 return; 5666 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 5667 if (!FD) 5668 return; 5669 5670 const ARMInterruptAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>(); 5671 if (!Attr) 5672 return; 5673 5674 const char *Kind; 5675 switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) { 5676 case ARMInterruptAttr::Generic: Kind = ""; break; 5677 case ARMInterruptAttr::IRQ: Kind = "IRQ"; break; 5678 case ARMInterruptAttr::FIQ: Kind = "FIQ"; break; 5679 case ARMInterruptAttr::SWI: Kind = "SWI"; break; 5680 case ARMInterruptAttr::ABORT: Kind = "ABORT"; break; 5681 case ARMInterruptAttr::UNDEF: Kind = "UNDEF"; break; 5682 } 5683 5684 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 5685 5686 Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind); 5687 5688 ARMABIInfo::ABIKind ABI = cast<ARMABIInfo>(getABIInfo()).getABIKind(); 5689 if (ABI == ARMABIInfo::APCS) 5690 return; 5691 5692 // AAPCS guarantees that sp will be 8-byte aligned on any public interface, 5693 // however this is not necessarily true on taking any interrupt. Instruct 5694 // the backend to perform a realignment as part of the function prologue. 5695 llvm::AttrBuilder B; 5696 B.addStackAlignmentAttr(8); 5697 Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B); 5698 } 5699 }; 5700 5701 class WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo : public ARMTargetCodeGenInfo { 5702 public: 5703 WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ARMABIInfo::ABIKind K) 5704 : ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, K) {} 5705 5706 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 5707 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 5708 5709 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 5710 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 5711 Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:" + qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib); 5712 } 5713 5714 void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, llvm::StringRef Value, 5715 llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override { 5716 Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\""; 5717 } 5718 }; 5719 5720 void WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 5721 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 5722 ARMTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 5723 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 5724 return; 5725 addStackProbeTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 5726 } 5727 } 5728 5729 void ARMABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 5730 if (!::classifyReturnType(getCXXABI(), FI, *this)) 5731 FI.getReturnInfo() = 5732 classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), FI.isVariadic()); 5733 5734 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 5735 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, FI.isVariadic()); 5736 5737 // Always honor user-specified calling convention. 5738 if (FI.getCallingConvention() != llvm::CallingConv::C) 5739 return; 5740 5741 llvm::CallingConv::ID cc = getRuntimeCC(); 5742 if (cc != llvm::CallingConv::C) 5743 FI.setEffectiveCallingConvention(cc); 5744 } 5745 5746 /// Return the default calling convention that LLVM will use. 5747 llvm::CallingConv::ID ARMABIInfo::getLLVMDefaultCC() const { 5748 // The default calling convention that LLVM will infer. 5749 if (isEABIHF() || getTarget().getTriple().isWatchABI()) 5750 return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP; 5751 else if (isEABI()) 5752 return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS; 5753 else 5754 return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_APCS; 5755 } 5756 5757 /// Return the calling convention that our ABI would like us to use 5758 /// as the C calling convention. 5759 llvm::CallingConv::ID ARMABIInfo::getABIDefaultCC() const { 5760 switch (getABIKind()) { 5761 case APCS: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_APCS; 5762 case AAPCS: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS; 5763 case AAPCS_VFP: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP; 5764 case AAPCS16_VFP: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP; 5765 } 5766 llvm_unreachable("bad ABI kind"); 5767 } 5768 5769 void ARMABIInfo::setCCs() { 5770 assert(getRuntimeCC() == llvm::CallingConv::C); 5771 5772 // Don't muddy up the IR with a ton of explicit annotations if 5773 // they'd just match what LLVM will infer from the triple. 5774 llvm::CallingConv::ID abiCC = getABIDefaultCC(); 5775 if (abiCC != getLLVMDefaultCC()) 5776 RuntimeCC = abiCC; 5777 } 5778 5779 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::coerceIllegalVector(QualType Ty) const { 5780 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 5781 if (Size <= 32) { 5782 llvm::Type *ResType = 5783 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5784 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5785 } 5786 if (Size == 64 || Size == 128) { 5787 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::VectorType::get( 5788 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), Size / 32); 5789 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5790 } 5791 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 5792 } 5793 5794 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyHomogeneousAggregate(QualType Ty, 5795 const Type *Base, 5796 uint64_t Members) const { 5797 assert(Base && "Base class should be set for homogeneous aggregate"); 5798 // Base can be a floating-point or a vector. 5799 if (const VectorType *VT = Base->getAs<VectorType>()) { 5800 // FP16 vectors should be converted to integer vectors 5801 if (!getTarget().hasLegalHalfType() && 5802 (VT->getElementType()->isFloat16Type() || 5803 VT->getElementType()->isHalfType())) { 5804 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 5805 llvm::Type *NewVecTy = llvm::VectorType::get( 5806 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), Size / 32); 5807 llvm::Type *Ty = llvm::ArrayType::get(NewVecTy, Members); 5808 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Ty, 0, nullptr, false); 5809 } 5810 } 5811 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false); 5812 } 5813 5814 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 5815 bool isVariadic) const { 5816 // 6.1.2.1 The following argument types are VFP CPRCs: 5817 // A single-precision floating-point type (including promoted 5818 // half-precision types); A double-precision floating-point type; 5819 // A 64-bit or 128-bit containerized vector type; Homogeneous Aggregate 5820 // with a Base Type of a single- or double-precision floating-point type, 5821 // 64-bit containerized vectors or 128-bit containerized vectors with one 5822 // to four Elements. 5823 bool IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP = getABIKind() == AAPCS_VFP && !isVariadic; 5824 5825 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 5826 5827 // Handle illegal vector types here. 5828 if (isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) 5829 return coerceIllegalVector(Ty); 5830 5831 // _Float16 and __fp16 get passed as if it were an int or float, but with 5832 // the top 16 bits unspecified. This is not done for OpenCL as it handles the 5833 // half type natively, and does not need to interwork with AAPCS code. 5834 if ((Ty->isFloat16Type() || Ty->isHalfType()) && 5835 !getContext().getLangOpts().NativeHalfArgsAndReturns) { 5836 llvm::Type *ResType = IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP ? 5837 llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()) : 5838 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5839 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5840 } 5841 5842 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 5843 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 5844 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) { 5845 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 5846 } 5847 5848 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty) 5849 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 5850 } 5851 5852 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) { 5853 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 5854 } 5855 5856 // Ignore empty records. 5857 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 5858 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5859 5860 if (IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP) { 5861 // Homogeneous Aggregates need to be expanded when we can fit the aggregate 5862 // into VFP registers. 5863 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5864 uint64_t Members = 0; 5865 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) 5866 return classifyHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members); 5867 } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP) { 5868 // WatchOS does have homogeneous aggregates. Note that we intentionally use 5869 // this convention even for a variadic function: the backend will use GPRs 5870 // if needed. 5871 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5872 uint64_t Members = 0; 5873 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 5874 assert(Base && Members <= 4 && "unexpected homogeneous aggregate"); 5875 llvm::Type *Ty = 5876 llvm::ArrayType::get(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)), Members); 5877 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Ty, 0, nullptr, false); 5878 } 5879 } 5880 5881 if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && 5882 getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)) { 5883 // WatchOS is adopting the 64-bit AAPCS rule on composite types: if they're 5884 // bigger than 128-bits, they get placed in space allocated by the caller, 5885 // and a pointer is passed. 5886 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect( 5887 CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8), false); 5888 } 5889 5890 // Support byval for ARM. 5891 // The ABI alignment for APCS is 4-byte and for AAPCS at least 4-byte and at 5892 // most 8-byte. We realign the indirect argument if type alignment is bigger 5893 // than ABI alignment. 5894 uint64_t ABIAlign = 4; 5895 uint64_t TyAlign; 5896 if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP || 5897 getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS) { 5898 TyAlign = getContext().getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(Ty).getQuantity(); 5899 ABIAlign = std::min(std::max(TyAlign, (uint64_t)4), (uint64_t)8); 5900 } else { 5901 TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty).getQuantity(); 5902 } 5903 if (getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(64)) { 5904 assert(getABIKind() != ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && "unexpected byval"); 5905 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(ABIAlign), 5906 /*ByVal=*/true, 5907 /*Realign=*/TyAlign > ABIAlign); 5908 } 5909 5910 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 64 bytes to an integer array of 5911 // same size and alignment. 5912 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 5913 return coerceToIntArray(Ty, getContext(), getVMContext()); 5914 } 5915 5916 // Otherwise, pass by coercing to a structure of the appropriate size. 5917 llvm::Type* ElemTy; 5918 unsigned SizeRegs; 5919 // FIXME: Try to match the types of the arguments more accurately where 5920 // we can. 5921 if (TyAlign <= 4) { 5922 ElemTy = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5923 SizeRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 5924 } else { 5925 ElemTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()); 5926 SizeRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 63) / 64; 5927 } 5928 5929 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(ElemTy, SizeRegs)); 5930 } 5931 5932 static bool isIntegerLikeType(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context, 5933 llvm::LLVMContext &VMContext) { 5934 // APCS, C Language Calling Conventions, Non-Simple Return Values: A structure 5935 // is called integer-like if its size is less than or equal to one word, and 5936 // the offset of each of its addressable sub-fields is zero. 5937 5938 uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 5939 5940 // Check that the type fits in a word. 5941 if (Size > 32) 5942 return false; 5943 5944 // FIXME: Handle vector types! 5945 if (Ty->isVectorType()) 5946 return false; 5947 5948 // Float types are never treated as "integer like". 5949 if (Ty->isRealFloatingType()) 5950 return false; 5951 5952 // If this is a builtin or pointer type then it is ok. 5953 if (Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() || Ty->isPointerType()) 5954 return true; 5955 5956 // Small complex integer types are "integer like". 5957 if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) 5958 return isIntegerLikeType(CT->getElementType(), Context, VMContext); 5959 5960 // Single element and zero sized arrays should be allowed, by the definition 5961 // above, but they are not. 5962 5963 // Otherwise, it must be a record type. 5964 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 5965 if (!RT) return false; 5966 5967 // Ignore records with flexible arrays. 5968 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 5969 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 5970 return false; 5971 5972 // Check that all sub-fields are at offset 0, and are themselves "integer 5973 // like". 5974 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD); 5975 5976 bool HadField = false; 5977 unsigned idx = 0; 5978 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 5979 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 5980 const FieldDecl *FD = *i; 5981 5982 // Bit-fields are not addressable, we only need to verify they are "integer 5983 // like". We still have to disallow a subsequent non-bitfield, for example: 5984 // struct { int : 0; int x } 5985 // is non-integer like according to gcc. 5986 if (FD->isBitField()) { 5987 if (!RD->isUnion()) 5988 HadField = true; 5989 5990 if (!isIntegerLikeType(FD->getType(), Context, VMContext)) 5991 return false; 5992 5993 continue; 5994 } 5995 5996 // Check if this field is at offset 0. 5997 if (Layout.getFieldOffset(idx) != 0) 5998 return false; 5999 6000 if (!isIntegerLikeType(FD->getType(), Context, VMContext)) 6001 return false; 6002 6003 // Only allow at most one field in a structure. This doesn't match the 6004 // wording above, but follows gcc in situations with a field following an 6005 // empty structure. 6006 if (!RD->isUnion()) { 6007 if (HadField) 6008 return false; 6009 6010 HadField = true; 6011 } 6012 } 6013 6014 return true; 6015 } 6016 6017 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, 6018 bool isVariadic) const { 6019 bool IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP = 6020 (getABIKind() == AAPCS_VFP || getABIKind() == AAPCS16_VFP) && !isVariadic; 6021 6022 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 6023 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6024 6025 if (const VectorType *VT = RetTy->getAs<VectorType>()) { 6026 // Large vector types should be returned via memory. 6027 if (getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 128) 6028 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 6029 // FP16 vectors should be converted to integer vectors 6030 if (!getTarget().hasLegalHalfType() && 6031 (VT->getElementType()->isFloat16Type() || 6032 VT->getElementType()->isHalfType())) 6033 return coerceIllegalVector(RetTy); 6034 } 6035 6036 // _Float16 and __fp16 get returned as if it were an int or float, but with 6037 // the top 16 bits unspecified. This is not done for OpenCL as it handles the 6038 // half type natively, and does not need to interwork with AAPCS code. 6039 if ((RetTy->isFloat16Type() || RetTy->isHalfType()) && 6040 !getContext().getLangOpts().NativeHalfArgsAndReturns) { 6041 llvm::Type *ResType = IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP ? 6042 llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()) : 6043 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 6044 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 6045 } 6046 6047 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 6048 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6049 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 6050 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6051 6052 return RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy) 6053 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6054 } 6055 6056 // Are we following APCS? 6057 if (getABIKind() == APCS) { 6058 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, false)) 6059 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6060 6061 // Complex types are all returned as packed integers. 6062 // 6063 // FIXME: Consider using 2 x vector types if the back end handles them 6064 // correctly. 6065 if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 6066 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get( 6067 getVMContext(), getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy))); 6068 6069 // Integer like structures are returned in r0. 6070 if (isIntegerLikeType(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext())) { 6071 // Return in the smallest viable integer type. 6072 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 6073 if (Size <= 8) 6074 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 6075 if (Size <= 16) 6076 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 6077 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 6078 } 6079 6080 // Otherwise return in memory. 6081 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 6082 } 6083 6084 // Otherwise this is an AAPCS variant. 6085 6086 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 6087 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6088 6089 // Check for homogeneous aggregates with AAPCS-VFP. 6090 if (IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP) { 6091 const Type *Base = nullptr; 6092 uint64_t Members = 0; 6093 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) 6094 return classifyHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members); 6095 } 6096 6097 // Aggregates <= 4 bytes are returned in r0; other aggregates 6098 // are returned indirectly. 6099 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 6100 if (Size <= 32) { 6101 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 4 bytes to an integer array of 6102 // same size and alignment. 6103 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 6104 return coerceToIntArray(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext()); 6105 } 6106 if (getDataLayout().isBigEndian()) 6107 // Return in 32 bit integer integer type (as if loaded by LDR, AAPCS 5.4) 6108 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 6109 6110 // Return in the smallest viable integer type. 6111 if (Size <= 8) 6112 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 6113 if (Size <= 16) 6114 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 6115 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 6116 } else if (Size <= 128 && getABIKind() == AAPCS16_VFP) { 6117 llvm::Type *Int32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 6118 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = 6119 llvm::ArrayType::get(Int32Ty, llvm::alignTo(Size, 32) / 32); 6120 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 6121 } 6122 6123 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 6124 } 6125 6126 /// isIllegalVector - check whether Ty is an illegal vector type. 6127 bool ARMABIInfo::isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 6128 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType> ()) { 6129 // On targets that don't support FP16, FP16 is expanded into float, and we 6130 // don't want the ABI to depend on whether or not FP16 is supported in 6131 // hardware. Thus return false to coerce FP16 vectors into integer vectors. 6132 if (!getTarget().hasLegalHalfType() && 6133 (VT->getElementType()->isFloat16Type() || 6134 VT->getElementType()->isHalfType())) 6135 return true; 6136 if (isAndroid()) { 6137 // Android shipped using Clang 3.1, which supported a slightly different 6138 // vector ABI. The primary differences were that 3-element vector types 6139 // were legal, and so were sub 32-bit vectors (i.e. <2 x i8>). This path 6140 // accepts that legacy behavior for Android only. 6141 // Check whether VT is legal. 6142 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 6143 // NumElements should be power of 2 or equal to 3. 6144 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements) && NumElements != 3) 6145 return true; 6146 } else { 6147 // Check whether VT is legal. 6148 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 6149 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 6150 // NumElements should be power of 2. 6151 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements)) 6152 return true; 6153 // Size should be greater than 32 bits. 6154 return Size <= 32; 6155 } 6156 } 6157 return false; 6158 } 6159 6160 bool ARMABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits vectorSize, 6161 llvm::Type *eltTy, 6162 unsigned numElts) const { 6163 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(numElts)) 6164 return false; 6165 unsigned size = getDataLayout().getTypeStoreSizeInBits(eltTy); 6166 if (size > 64) 6167 return false; 6168 if (vectorSize.getQuantity() != 8 && 6169 (vectorSize.getQuantity() != 16 || numElts == 1)) 6170 return false; 6171 return true; 6172 } 6173 6174 bool ARMABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 6175 // Homogeneous aggregates for AAPCS-VFP must have base types of float, 6176 // double, or 64-bit or 128-bit vectors. 6177 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 6178 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 6179 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double || 6180 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) 6181 return true; 6182 } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 6183 unsigned VecSize = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 6184 if (VecSize == 64 || VecSize == 128) 6185 return true; 6186 } 6187 return false; 6188 } 6189 6190 bool ARMABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base, 6191 uint64_t Members) const { 6192 return Members <= 4; 6193 } 6194 6195 Address ARMABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6196 QualType Ty) const { 6197 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 6198 6199 // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes. 6200 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) { 6201 Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize); 6202 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty)); 6203 return Addr; 6204 } 6205 6206 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 6207 CharUnits TyAlignForABI = TyInfo.second; 6208 6209 // Use indirect if size of the illegal vector is bigger than 16 bytes. 6210 bool IsIndirect = false; 6211 const Type *Base = nullptr; 6212 uint64_t Members = 0; 6213 if (TyInfo.first > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16) && isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 6214 IsIndirect = true; 6215 6216 // ARMv7k passes structs bigger than 16 bytes indirectly, in space 6217 // allocated by the caller. 6218 } else if (TyInfo.first > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16) && 6219 getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && 6220 !isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 6221 IsIndirect = true; 6222 6223 // Otherwise, bound the type's ABI alignment. 6224 // The ABI alignment for 64-bit or 128-bit vectors is 8 for AAPCS and 4 for 6225 // APCS. For AAPCS, the ABI alignment is at least 4-byte and at most 8-byte. 6226 // Our callers should be prepared to handle an under-aligned address. 6227 } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP || 6228 getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS) { 6229 TyAlignForABI = std::max(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4)); 6230 TyAlignForABI = std::min(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 6231 } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP) { 6232 // ARMv7k allows type alignment up to 16 bytes. 6233 TyAlignForABI = std::max(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4)); 6234 TyAlignForABI = std::min(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 6235 } else { 6236 TyAlignForABI = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 6237 } 6238 TyInfo.second = TyAlignForABI; 6239 6240 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, TyInfo, 6241 SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 6242 } 6243 6244 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6245 // NVPTX ABI Implementation 6246 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6247 6248 namespace { 6249 6250 class NVPTXABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 6251 public: 6252 NVPTXABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 6253 6254 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 6255 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 6256 6257 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 6258 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6259 QualType Ty) const override; 6260 }; 6261 6262 class NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6263 public: 6264 NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6265 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new NVPTXABIInfo(CGT)) {} 6266 6267 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6268 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 6269 bool shouldEmitStaticExternCAliases() const override; 6270 6271 private: 6272 // Adds a NamedMDNode with F, Name, and Operand as operands, and adds the 6273 // resulting MDNode to the nvvm.annotations MDNode. 6274 static void addNVVMMetadata(llvm::Function *F, StringRef Name, int Operand); 6275 }; 6276 6277 /// Checks if the type is unsupported directly by the current target. 6278 static bool isUnsupportedType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) { 6279 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat16Type() && T->isFloat16Type()) 6280 return true; 6281 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type() && T->isFloat128Type()) 6282 return true; 6283 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() && T->isIntegerType() && 6284 Context.getTypeSize(T) > 64) 6285 return true; 6286 if (const auto *AT = T->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()) 6287 return isUnsupportedType(Context, AT->getElementType()); 6288 const auto *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 6289 if (!RT) 6290 return false; 6291 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6292 6293 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 6294 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 6295 for (const CXXBaseSpecifier &I : CXXRD->bases()) 6296 if (isUnsupportedType(Context, I.getType())) 6297 return true; 6298 6299 for (const FieldDecl *I : RD->fields()) 6300 if (isUnsupportedType(Context, I->getType())) 6301 return true; 6302 return false; 6303 } 6304 6305 /// Coerce the given type into an array with maximum allowed size of elements. 6306 static ABIArgInfo coerceToIntArrayWithLimit(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context, 6307 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext, 6308 unsigned MaxSize) { 6309 // Alignment and Size are measured in bits. 6310 const uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 6311 const uint64_t Alignment = Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 6312 const unsigned Div = std::min<unsigned>(MaxSize, Alignment); 6313 llvm::Type *IntType = llvm::Type::getIntNTy(LLVMContext, Div); 6314 const uint64_t NumElements = (Size + Div - 1) / Div; 6315 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(IntType, NumElements)); 6316 } 6317 6318 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 6319 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 6320 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6321 6322 if (getContext().getLangOpts().OpenMP && 6323 getContext().getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice && 6324 isUnsupportedType(getContext(), RetTy)) 6325 return coerceToIntArrayWithLimit(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext(), 64); 6326 6327 // note: this is different from default ABI 6328 if (!RetTy->isScalarType()) 6329 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6330 6331 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6332 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 6333 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6334 6335 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy) 6336 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6337 } 6338 6339 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6340 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6341 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 6342 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6343 6344 // Return aggregates type as indirect by value 6345 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) 6346 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /* byval */ true); 6347 6348 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty) 6349 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6350 } 6351 6352 void NVPTXABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 6353 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 6354 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 6355 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 6356 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 6357 6358 // Always honor user-specified calling convention. 6359 if (FI.getCallingConvention() != llvm::CallingConv::C) 6360 return; 6361 6362 FI.setEffectiveCallingConvention(getRuntimeCC()); 6363 } 6364 6365 Address NVPTXABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6366 QualType Ty) const { 6367 llvm_unreachable("NVPTX does not support varargs"); 6368 } 6369 6370 void NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 6371 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const { 6372 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 6373 return; 6374 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 6375 if (!FD) return; 6376 6377 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6378 6379 // Perform special handling in OpenCL mode 6380 if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 6381 // Use OpenCL function attributes to check for kernel functions 6382 // By default, all functions are device functions 6383 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 6384 // OpenCL __kernel functions get kernel metadata 6385 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"kernel", i32 1} node 6386 addNVVMMetadata(F, "kernel", 1); 6387 // And kernel functions are not subject to inlining 6388 F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline); 6389 } 6390 } 6391 6392 // Perform special handling in CUDA mode. 6393 if (M.getLangOpts().CUDA) { 6394 // CUDA __global__ functions get a kernel metadata entry. Since 6395 // __global__ functions cannot be called from the device, we do not 6396 // need to set the noinline attribute. 6397 if (FD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) { 6398 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"kernel", i32 1} node 6399 addNVVMMetadata(F, "kernel", 1); 6400 } 6401 if (CUDALaunchBoundsAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<CUDALaunchBoundsAttr>()) { 6402 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"maxntidx", i32 <val>} node 6403 llvm::APSInt MaxThreads(32); 6404 MaxThreads = Attr->getMaxThreads()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()); 6405 if (MaxThreads > 0) 6406 addNVVMMetadata(F, "maxntidx", MaxThreads.getExtValue()); 6407 6408 // min blocks is an optional argument for CUDALaunchBoundsAttr. If it was 6409 // not specified in __launch_bounds__ or if the user specified a 0 value, 6410 // we don't have to add a PTX directive. 6411 if (Attr->getMinBlocks()) { 6412 llvm::APSInt MinBlocks(32); 6413 MinBlocks = Attr->getMinBlocks()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()); 6414 if (MinBlocks > 0) 6415 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"minctasm", i32 <val>} node 6416 addNVVMMetadata(F, "minctasm", MinBlocks.getExtValue()); 6417 } 6418 } 6419 } 6420 } 6421 6422 void NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo::addNVVMMetadata(llvm::Function *F, StringRef Name, 6423 int Operand) { 6424 llvm::Module *M = F->getParent(); 6425 llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = M->getContext(); 6426 6427 // Get "nvvm.annotations" metadata node 6428 llvm::NamedMDNode *MD = M->getOrInsertNamedMetadata("nvvm.annotations"); 6429 6430 llvm::Metadata *MDVals[] = { 6431 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(F), llvm::MDString::get(Ctx, Name), 6432 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get( 6433 llvm::ConstantInt::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(Ctx), Operand))}; 6434 // Append metadata to nvvm.annotations 6435 MD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, MDVals)); 6436 } 6437 6438 bool NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo::shouldEmitStaticExternCAliases() const { 6439 return false; 6440 } 6441 } 6442 6443 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6444 // SystemZ ABI Implementation 6445 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6446 6447 namespace { 6448 6449 class SystemZABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 6450 bool HasVector; 6451 6452 public: 6453 SystemZABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool HV) 6454 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), HasVector(HV) {} 6455 6456 bool isPromotableIntegerType(QualType Ty) const; 6457 bool isCompoundType(QualType Ty) const; 6458 bool isVectorArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 6459 bool isFPArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 6460 QualType GetSingleElementType(QualType Ty) const; 6461 6462 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 6463 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType ArgTy) const; 6464 6465 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 6466 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 6467 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 6468 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 6469 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 6470 } 6471 6472 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6473 QualType Ty) const override; 6474 6475 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 6476 bool asReturnValue) const override { 6477 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 6478 } 6479 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 6480 return false; 6481 } 6482 }; 6483 6484 class SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6485 public: 6486 SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool HasVector) 6487 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SystemZABIInfo(CGT, HasVector)) {} 6488 }; 6489 6490 } 6491 6492 bool SystemZABIInfo::isPromotableIntegerType(QualType Ty) const { 6493 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6494 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 6495 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6496 6497 // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI. 6498 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) 6499 return true; 6500 6501 // 32-bit values must also be promoted. 6502 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 6503 switch (BT->getKind()) { 6504 case BuiltinType::Int: 6505 case BuiltinType::UInt: 6506 return true; 6507 default: 6508 return false; 6509 } 6510 return false; 6511 } 6512 6513 bool SystemZABIInfo::isCompoundType(QualType Ty) const { 6514 return (Ty->isAnyComplexType() || 6515 Ty->isVectorType() || 6516 isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)); 6517 } 6518 6519 bool SystemZABIInfo::isVectorArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6520 return (HasVector && 6521 Ty->isVectorType() && 6522 getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 128); 6523 } 6524 6525 bool SystemZABIInfo::isFPArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6526 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 6527 switch (BT->getKind()) { 6528 case BuiltinType::Float: 6529 case BuiltinType::Double: 6530 return true; 6531 default: 6532 return false; 6533 } 6534 6535 return false; 6536 } 6537 6538 QualType SystemZABIInfo::GetSingleElementType(QualType Ty) const { 6539 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAsStructureType()) { 6540 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6541 QualType Found; 6542 6543 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 6544 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 6545 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 6546 QualType Base = I.getType(); 6547 6548 // Empty bases don't affect things either way. 6549 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Base, true)) 6550 continue; 6551 6552 if (!Found.isNull()) 6553 return Ty; 6554 Found = GetSingleElementType(Base); 6555 } 6556 6557 // Check the fields. 6558 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 6559 // For compatibility with GCC, ignore empty bitfields in C++ mode. 6560 // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), empty structure and array fields 6561 // do count. So do anonymous bitfields that aren't zero-sized. 6562 if (getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6563 FD->isZeroLengthBitField(getContext())) 6564 continue; 6565 6566 // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), arrays do not count. 6567 // Nested structures still do though. 6568 if (!Found.isNull()) 6569 return Ty; 6570 Found = GetSingleElementType(FD->getType()); 6571 } 6572 6573 // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), trailing padding is allowed. 6574 // An 8-byte aligned struct s { float f; } is passed as a double. 6575 if (!Found.isNull()) 6576 return Found; 6577 } 6578 6579 return Ty; 6580 } 6581 6582 Address SystemZABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6583 QualType Ty) const { 6584 // Assume that va_list type is correct; should be pointer to LLVM type: 6585 // struct { 6586 // i64 __gpr; 6587 // i64 __fpr; 6588 // i8 *__overflow_arg_area; 6589 // i8 *__reg_save_area; 6590 // }; 6591 6592 // Every non-vector argument occupies 8 bytes and is passed by preference 6593 // in either GPRs or FPRs. Vector arguments occupy 8 or 16 bytes and are 6594 // always passed on the stack. 6595 Ty = getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty); 6596 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 6597 llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 6598 llvm::Type *DirectTy = ArgTy; 6599 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty); 6600 bool IsIndirect = AI.isIndirect(); 6601 bool InFPRs = false; 6602 bool IsVector = false; 6603 CharUnits UnpaddedSize; 6604 CharUnits DirectAlign; 6605 if (IsIndirect) { 6606 DirectTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(DirectTy); 6607 UnpaddedSize = DirectAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 6608 } else { 6609 if (AI.getCoerceToType()) 6610 ArgTy = AI.getCoerceToType(); 6611 InFPRs = ArgTy->isFloatTy() || ArgTy->isDoubleTy(); 6612 IsVector = ArgTy->isVectorTy(); 6613 UnpaddedSize = TyInfo.first; 6614 DirectAlign = TyInfo.second; 6615 } 6616 CharUnits PaddedSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 6617 if (IsVector && UnpaddedSize > PaddedSize) 6618 PaddedSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 6619 assert((UnpaddedSize <= PaddedSize) && "Invalid argument size."); 6620 6621 CharUnits Padding = (PaddedSize - UnpaddedSize); 6622 6623 llvm::Type *IndexTy = CGF.Int64Ty; 6624 llvm::Value *PaddedSizeV = 6625 llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, PaddedSize.getQuantity()); 6626 6627 if (IsVector) { 6628 // Work out the address of a vector argument on the stack. 6629 // Vector arguments are always passed in the high bits of a 6630 // single (8 byte) or double (16 byte) stack slot. 6631 Address OverflowArgAreaPtr = 6632 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, "overflow_arg_area_ptr"); 6633 Address OverflowArgArea = 6634 Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowArgAreaPtr, "overflow_arg_area"), 6635 TyInfo.second); 6636 Address MemAddr = 6637 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OverflowArgArea, DirectTy, "mem_addr"); 6638 6639 // Update overflow_arg_area_ptr pointer 6640 llvm::Value *NewOverflowArgArea = 6641 CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(OverflowArgArea.getPointer(), PaddedSizeV, 6642 "overflow_arg_area"); 6643 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOverflowArgArea, OverflowArgAreaPtr); 6644 6645 return MemAddr; 6646 } 6647 6648 assert(PaddedSize.getQuantity() == 8); 6649 6650 unsigned MaxRegs, RegCountField, RegSaveIndex; 6651 CharUnits RegPadding; 6652 if (InFPRs) { 6653 MaxRegs = 4; // Maximum of 4 FPR arguments 6654 RegCountField = 1; // __fpr 6655 RegSaveIndex = 16; // save offset for f0 6656 RegPadding = CharUnits(); // floats are passed in the high bits of an FPR 6657 } else { 6658 MaxRegs = 5; // Maximum of 5 GPR arguments 6659 RegCountField = 0; // __gpr 6660 RegSaveIndex = 2; // save offset for r2 6661 RegPadding = Padding; // values are passed in the low bits of a GPR 6662 } 6663 6664 Address RegCountPtr = 6665 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, RegCountField, "reg_count_ptr"); 6666 llvm::Value *RegCount = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RegCountPtr, "reg_count"); 6667 llvm::Value *MaxRegsV = llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, MaxRegs); 6668 llvm::Value *InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULT(RegCount, MaxRegsV, 6669 "fits_in_regs"); 6670 6671 llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg"); 6672 llvm::BasicBlock *InMemBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_mem"); 6673 llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end"); 6674 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, InMemBlock); 6675 6676 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in registers. 6677 CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock); 6678 6679 // Work out the address of an argument register. 6680 llvm::Value *ScaledRegCount = 6681 CGF.Builder.CreateMul(RegCount, PaddedSizeV, "scaled_reg_count"); 6682 llvm::Value *RegBase = 6683 llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, RegSaveIndex * PaddedSize.getQuantity() 6684 + RegPadding.getQuantity()); 6685 llvm::Value *RegOffset = 6686 CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(ScaledRegCount, RegBase, "reg_offset"); 6687 Address RegSaveAreaPtr = 6688 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, "reg_save_area_ptr"); 6689 llvm::Value *RegSaveArea = 6690 CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RegSaveAreaPtr, "reg_save_area"); 6691 Address RawRegAddr(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, RegOffset, 6692 "raw_reg_addr"), 6693 PaddedSize); 6694 Address RegAddr = 6695 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RawRegAddr, DirectTy, "reg_addr"); 6696 6697 // Update the register count 6698 llvm::Value *One = llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, 1); 6699 llvm::Value *NewRegCount = 6700 CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(RegCount, One, "reg_count"); 6701 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewRegCount, RegCountPtr); 6702 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 6703 6704 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in memory. 6705 CGF.EmitBlock(InMemBlock); 6706 6707 // Work out the address of a stack argument. 6708 Address OverflowArgAreaPtr = 6709 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, "overflow_arg_area_ptr"); 6710 Address OverflowArgArea = 6711 Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowArgAreaPtr, "overflow_arg_area"), 6712 PaddedSize); 6713 Address RawMemAddr = 6714 CGF.Builder.CreateConstByteGEP(OverflowArgArea, Padding, "raw_mem_addr"); 6715 Address MemAddr = 6716 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RawMemAddr, DirectTy, "mem_addr"); 6717 6718 // Update overflow_arg_area_ptr pointer 6719 llvm::Value *NewOverflowArgArea = 6720 CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(OverflowArgArea.getPointer(), PaddedSizeV, 6721 "overflow_arg_area"); 6722 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOverflowArgArea, OverflowArgAreaPtr); 6723 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 6724 6725 // Return the appropriate result. 6726 CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock); 6727 Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, 6728 MemAddr, InMemBlock, "va_arg.addr"); 6729 6730 if (IsIndirect) 6731 ResAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ResAddr, "indirect_arg"), 6732 TyInfo.second); 6733 6734 return ResAddr; 6735 } 6736 6737 ABIArgInfo SystemZABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 6738 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 6739 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6740 if (isVectorArgumentType(RetTy)) 6741 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6742 if (isCompoundType(RetTy) || getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 64) 6743 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 6744 return (isPromotableIntegerType(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy) 6745 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6746 } 6747 6748 ABIArgInfo SystemZABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6749 // Handle the generic C++ ABI. 6750 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 6751 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 6752 6753 // Integers and enums are extended to full register width. 6754 if (isPromotableIntegerType(Ty)) 6755 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty); 6756 6757 // Handle vector types and vector-like structure types. Note that 6758 // as opposed to float-like structure types, we do not allow any 6759 // padding for vector-like structures, so verify the sizes match. 6760 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 6761 QualType SingleElementTy = GetSingleElementType(Ty); 6762 if (isVectorArgumentType(SingleElementTy) && 6763 getContext().getTypeSize(SingleElementTy) == Size) 6764 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(SingleElementTy)); 6765 6766 // Values that are not 1, 2, 4 or 8 bytes in size are passed indirectly. 6767 if (Size != 8 && Size != 16 && Size != 32 && Size != 64) 6768 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 6769 6770 // Handle small structures. 6771 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 6772 // Structures with flexible arrays have variable length, so really 6773 // fail the size test above. 6774 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6775 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 6776 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 6777 6778 // The structure is passed as an unextended integer, a float, or a double. 6779 llvm::Type *PassTy; 6780 if (isFPArgumentType(SingleElementTy)) { 6781 assert(Size == 32 || Size == 64); 6782 if (Size == 32) 6783 PassTy = llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()); 6784 else 6785 PassTy = llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()); 6786 } else 6787 PassTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size); 6788 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(PassTy); 6789 } 6790 6791 // Non-structure compounds are passed indirectly. 6792 if (isCompoundType(Ty)) 6793 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 6794 6795 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr); 6796 } 6797 6798 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6799 // MSP430 ABI Implementation 6800 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6801 6802 namespace { 6803 6804 class MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6805 public: 6806 MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6807 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {} 6808 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6809 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 6810 }; 6811 6812 } 6813 6814 void MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 6815 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const { 6816 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 6817 return; 6818 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 6819 const auto *InterruptAttr = FD->getAttr<MSP430InterruptAttr>(); 6820 if (!InterruptAttr) 6821 return; 6822 6823 // Handle 'interrupt' attribute: 6824 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6825 6826 // Step 1: Set ISR calling convention. 6827 F->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::MSP430_INTR); 6828 6829 // Step 2: Add attributes goodness. 6830 F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline); 6831 F->addFnAttr("interrupt", llvm::utostr(InterruptAttr->getNumber())); 6832 } 6833 } 6834 6835 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6836 // MIPS ABI Implementation. This works for both little-endian and 6837 // big-endian variants. 6838 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6839 6840 namespace { 6841 class MipsABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 6842 bool IsO32; 6843 unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes, StackAlignInBytes; 6844 void CoerceToIntArgs(uint64_t TySize, 6845 SmallVectorImpl<llvm::Type *> &ArgList) const; 6846 llvm::Type* HandleAggregates(QualType Ty, uint64_t TySize) const; 6847 llvm::Type* returnAggregateInRegs(QualType RetTy, uint64_t Size) const; 6848 llvm::Type* getPaddingType(uint64_t Align, uint64_t Offset) const; 6849 public: 6850 MipsABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool _IsO32) : 6851 ABIInfo(CGT), IsO32(_IsO32), MinABIStackAlignInBytes(IsO32 ? 4 : 8), 6852 StackAlignInBytes(IsO32 ? 8 : 16) {} 6853 6854 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 6855 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, uint64_t &Offset) const; 6856 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 6857 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6858 QualType Ty) const override; 6859 ABIArgInfo extendType(QualType Ty) const; 6860 }; 6861 6862 class MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6863 unsigned SizeOfUnwindException; 6864 public: 6865 MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool IsO32) 6866 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new MipsABIInfo(CGT, IsO32)), 6867 SizeOfUnwindException(IsO32 ? 24 : 32) {} 6868 6869 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 6870 return 29; 6871 } 6872 6873 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6874 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 6875 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 6876 if (!FD) return; 6877 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6878 6879 if (FD->hasAttr<MipsLongCallAttr>()) 6880 Fn->addFnAttr("long-call"); 6881 else if (FD->hasAttr<MipsShortCallAttr>()) 6882 Fn->addFnAttr("short-call"); 6883 6884 // Other attributes do not have a meaning for declarations. 6885 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 6886 return; 6887 6888 if (FD->hasAttr<Mips16Attr>()) { 6889 Fn->addFnAttr("mips16"); 6890 } 6891 else if (FD->hasAttr<NoMips16Attr>()) { 6892 Fn->addFnAttr("nomips16"); 6893 } 6894 6895 if (FD->hasAttr<MicroMipsAttr>()) 6896 Fn->addFnAttr("micromips"); 6897 else if (FD->hasAttr<NoMicroMipsAttr>()) 6898 Fn->addFnAttr("nomicromips"); 6899 6900 const MipsInterruptAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<MipsInterruptAttr>(); 6901 if (!Attr) 6902 return; 6903 6904 const char *Kind; 6905 switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) { 6906 case MipsInterruptAttr::eic: Kind = "eic"; break; 6907 case MipsInterruptAttr::sw0: Kind = "sw0"; break; 6908 case MipsInterruptAttr::sw1: Kind = "sw1"; break; 6909 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw0: Kind = "hw0"; break; 6910 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw1: Kind = "hw1"; break; 6911 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw2: Kind = "hw2"; break; 6912 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw3: Kind = "hw3"; break; 6913 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw4: Kind = "hw4"; break; 6914 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw5: Kind = "hw5"; break; 6915 } 6916 6917 Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind); 6918 6919 } 6920 6921 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 6922 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 6923 6924 unsigned getSizeOfUnwindException() const override { 6925 return SizeOfUnwindException; 6926 } 6927 }; 6928 } 6929 6930 void MipsABIInfo::CoerceToIntArgs( 6931 uint64_t TySize, SmallVectorImpl<llvm::Type *> &ArgList) const { 6932 llvm::IntegerType *IntTy = 6933 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); 6934 6935 // Add (TySize / MinABIStackAlignInBytes) args of IntTy. 6936 for (unsigned N = TySize / (MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); N; --N) 6937 ArgList.push_back(IntTy); 6938 6939 // If necessary, add one more integer type to ArgList. 6940 unsigned R = TySize % (MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); 6941 6942 if (R) 6943 ArgList.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), R)); 6944 } 6945 6946 // In N32/64, an aligned double precision floating point field is passed in 6947 // a register. 6948 llvm::Type* MipsABIInfo::HandleAggregates(QualType Ty, uint64_t TySize) const { 6949 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> ArgList, IntArgList; 6950 6951 if (IsO32) { 6952 CoerceToIntArgs(TySize, ArgList); 6953 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList); 6954 } 6955 6956 if (Ty->isComplexType()) 6957 return CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 6958 6959 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 6960 6961 // Unions/vectors are passed in integer registers. 6962 if (!RT || !RT->isStructureOrClassType()) { 6963 CoerceToIntArgs(TySize, ArgList); 6964 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList); 6965 } 6966 6967 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6968 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD); 6969 assert(!(TySize % 8) && "Size of structure must be multiple of 8."); 6970 6971 uint64_t LastOffset = 0; 6972 unsigned idx = 0; 6973 llvm::IntegerType *I64 = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 64); 6974 6975 // Iterate over fields in the struct/class and check if there are any aligned 6976 // double fields. 6977 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 6978 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 6979 const QualType Ty = i->getType(); 6980 const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 6981 6982 if (!BT || BT->getKind() != BuiltinType::Double) 6983 continue; 6984 6985 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 6986 if (Offset % 64) // Ignore doubles that are not aligned. 6987 continue; 6988 6989 // Add ((Offset - LastOffset) / 64) args of type i64. 6990 for (unsigned j = (Offset - LastOffset) / 64; j > 0; --j) 6991 ArgList.push_back(I64); 6992 6993 // Add double type. 6994 ArgList.push_back(llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext())); 6995 LastOffset = Offset + 64; 6996 } 6997 6998 CoerceToIntArgs(TySize - LastOffset, IntArgList); 6999 ArgList.append(IntArgList.begin(), IntArgList.end()); 7000 7001 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList); 7002 } 7003 7004 llvm::Type *MipsABIInfo::getPaddingType(uint64_t OrigOffset, 7005 uint64_t Offset) const { 7006 if (OrigOffset + MinABIStackAlignInBytes > Offset) 7007 return nullptr; 7008 7009 return llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), (Offset - OrigOffset) * 8); 7010 } 7011 7012 ABIArgInfo 7013 MipsABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, uint64_t &Offset) const { 7014 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 7015 7016 uint64_t OrigOffset = Offset; 7017 uint64_t TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 7018 uint64_t Align = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 7019 7020 Align = std::min(std::max(Align, (uint64_t)MinABIStackAlignInBytes), 7021 (uint64_t)StackAlignInBytes); 7022 unsigned CurrOffset = llvm::alignTo(Offset, Align); 7023 Offset = CurrOffset + llvm::alignTo(TySize, Align * 8) / 8; 7024 7025 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) || Ty->isVectorType()) { 7026 // Ignore empty aggregates. 7027 if (TySize == 0) 7028 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7029 7030 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) { 7031 Offset = OrigOffset + MinABIStackAlignInBytes; 7032 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 7033 } 7034 7035 // If we have reached here, aggregates are passed directly by coercing to 7036 // another structure type. Padding is inserted if the offset of the 7037 // aggregate is unaligned. 7038 ABIArgInfo ArgInfo = 7039 ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HandleAggregates(Ty, TySize), 0, 7040 getPaddingType(OrigOffset, CurrOffset)); 7041 ArgInfo.setInReg(true); 7042 return ArgInfo; 7043 } 7044 7045 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 7046 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 7047 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7048 7049 // All integral types are promoted to the GPR width. 7050 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 7051 return extendType(Ty); 7052 7053 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect( 7054 nullptr, 0, IsO32 ? nullptr : getPaddingType(OrigOffset, CurrOffset)); 7055 } 7056 7057 llvm::Type* 7058 MipsABIInfo::returnAggregateInRegs(QualType RetTy, uint64_t Size) const { 7059 const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>(); 7060 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> RTList; 7061 7062 if (RT && RT->isStructureOrClassType()) { 7063 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 7064 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD); 7065 unsigned FieldCnt = Layout.getFieldCount(); 7066 7067 // N32/64 returns struct/classes in floating point registers if the 7068 // following conditions are met: 7069 // 1. The size of the struct/class is no larger than 128-bit. 7070 // 2. The struct/class has one or two fields all of which are floating 7071 // point types. 7072 // 3. The offset of the first field is zero (this follows what gcc does). 7073 // 7074 // Any other composite results are returned in integer registers. 7075 // 7076 if (FieldCnt && (FieldCnt <= 2) && !Layout.getFieldOffset(0)) { 7077 RecordDecl::field_iterator b = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 7078 for (; b != e; ++b) { 7079 const BuiltinType *BT = b->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 7080 7081 if (!BT || !BT->isFloatingPoint()) 7082 break; 7083 7084 RTList.push_back(CGT.ConvertType(b->getType())); 7085 } 7086 7087 if (b == e) 7088 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), RTList, 7089 RD->hasAttr<PackedAttr>()); 7090 7091 RTList.clear(); 7092 } 7093 } 7094 7095 CoerceToIntArgs(Size, RTList); 7096 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), RTList); 7097 } 7098 7099 ABIArgInfo MipsABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 7100 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 7101 7102 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 7103 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7104 7105 // O32 doesn't treat zero-sized structs differently from other structs. 7106 // However, N32/N64 ignores zero sized return values. 7107 if (!IsO32 && Size == 0) 7108 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7109 7110 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy) || RetTy->isVectorType()) { 7111 if (Size <= 128) { 7112 if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 7113 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7114 7115 // O32 returns integer vectors in registers and N32/N64 returns all small 7116 // aggregates in registers. 7117 if (!IsO32 || 7118 (RetTy->isVectorType() && !RetTy->hasFloatingRepresentation())) { 7119 ABIArgInfo ArgInfo = 7120 ABIArgInfo::getDirect(returnAggregateInRegs(RetTy, Size)); 7121 ArgInfo.setInReg(true); 7122 return ArgInfo; 7123 } 7124 } 7125 7126 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 7127 } 7128 7129 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 7130 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 7131 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7132 7133 if (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) 7134 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy); 7135 7136 if ((RetTy->isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() || 7137 RetTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()) && Size == 32 && !IsO32) 7138 return ABIArgInfo::getSignExtend(RetTy); 7139 7140 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7141 } 7142 7143 void MipsABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 7144 ABIArgInfo &RetInfo = FI.getReturnInfo(); 7145 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 7146 RetInfo = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 7147 7148 // Check if a pointer to an aggregate is passed as a hidden argument. 7149 uint64_t Offset = RetInfo.isIndirect() ? MinABIStackAlignInBytes : 0; 7150 7151 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 7152 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, Offset); 7153 } 7154 7155 Address MipsABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7156 QualType OrigTy) const { 7157 QualType Ty = OrigTy; 7158 7159 // Integer arguments are promoted to 32-bit on O32 and 64-bit on N32/N64. 7160 // Pointers are also promoted in the same way but this only matters for N32. 7161 unsigned SlotSizeInBits = IsO32 ? 32 : 64; 7162 unsigned PtrWidth = getTarget().getPointerWidth(0); 7163 bool DidPromote = false; 7164 if ((Ty->isIntegerType() && 7165 getContext().getIntWidth(Ty) < SlotSizeInBits) || 7166 (Ty->isPointerType() && PtrWidth < SlotSizeInBits)) { 7167 DidPromote = true; 7168 Ty = getContext().getIntTypeForBitwidth(SlotSizeInBits, 7169 Ty->isSignedIntegerType()); 7170 } 7171 7172 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 7173 7174 // The alignment of things in the argument area is never larger than 7175 // StackAlignInBytes. 7176 TyInfo.second = 7177 std::min(TyInfo.second, CharUnits::fromQuantity(StackAlignInBytes)); 7178 7179 // MinABIStackAlignInBytes is the size of argument slots on the stack. 7180 CharUnits ArgSlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(MinABIStackAlignInBytes); 7181 7182 Address Addr = emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 7183 TyInfo, ArgSlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 7184 7185 7186 // If there was a promotion, "unpromote" into a temporary. 7187 // TODO: can we just use a pointer into a subset of the original slot? 7188 if (DidPromote) { 7189 Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(OrigTy, "vaarg.promotion-temp"); 7190 llvm::Value *Promoted = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(Addr); 7191 7192 // Truncate down to the right width. 7193 llvm::Type *IntTy = (OrigTy->isIntegerType() ? Temp.getElementType() 7194 : CGF.IntPtrTy); 7195 llvm::Value *V = CGF.Builder.CreateTrunc(Promoted, IntTy); 7196 if (OrigTy->isPointerType()) 7197 V = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(V, Temp.getElementType()); 7198 7199 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, Temp); 7200 Addr = Temp; 7201 } 7202 7203 return Addr; 7204 } 7205 7206 ABIArgInfo MipsABIInfo::extendType(QualType Ty) const { 7207 int TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 7208 7209 // MIPS64 ABI requires unsigned 32 bit integers to be sign extended. 7210 if (Ty->isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() && TySize == 32) 7211 return ABIArgInfo::getSignExtend(Ty); 7212 7213 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty); 7214 } 7215 7216 bool 7217 MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 7218 llvm::Value *Address) const { 7219 // This information comes from gcc's implementation, which seems to 7220 // as canonical as it gets. 7221 7222 // Everything on MIPS is 4 bytes. Double-precision FP registers 7223 // are aliased to pairs of single-precision FP registers. 7224 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4); 7225 7226 // 0-31 are the general purpose registers, $0 - $31. 7227 // 32-63 are the floating-point registers, $f0 - $f31. 7228 // 64 and 65 are the multiply/divide registers, $hi and $lo. 7229 // 66 is the (notional, I think) register for signal-handler return. 7230 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 65); 7231 7232 // 67-74 are the floating-point status registers, $fcc0 - $fcc7. 7233 // They are one bit wide and ignored here. 7234 7235 // 80-111 are the coprocessor 0 registers, $c0r0 - $c0r31. 7236 // (coprocessor 1 is the FP unit) 7237 // 112-143 are the coprocessor 2 registers, $c2r0 - $c2r31. 7238 // 144-175 are the coprocessor 3 registers, $c3r0 - $c3r31. 7239 // 176-181 are the DSP accumulator registers. 7240 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 80, 181); 7241 return false; 7242 } 7243 7244 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7245 // AVR ABI Implementation. 7246 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7247 7248 namespace { 7249 class AVRTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7250 public: 7251 AVRTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7252 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) { } 7253 7254 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 7255 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 7256 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 7257 return; 7258 const auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 7259 if (!FD) return; 7260 auto *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 7261 7262 if (FD->getAttr<AVRInterruptAttr>()) 7263 Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt"); 7264 7265 if (FD->getAttr<AVRSignalAttr>()) 7266 Fn->addFnAttr("signal"); 7267 } 7268 }; 7269 } 7270 7271 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7272 // TCE ABI Implementation (see http://tce.cs.tut.fi). Uses mostly the defaults. 7273 // Currently subclassed only to implement custom OpenCL C function attribute 7274 // handling. 7275 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7276 7277 namespace { 7278 7279 class TCETargetCodeGenInfo : public DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo { 7280 public: 7281 TCETargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7282 : DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT) {} 7283 7284 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 7285 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 7286 }; 7287 7288 void TCETargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 7289 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const { 7290 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 7291 return; 7292 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 7293 if (!FD) return; 7294 7295 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 7296 7297 if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7298 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 7299 // OpenCL C Kernel functions are not subject to inlining 7300 F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline); 7301 const ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr>(); 7302 if (Attr) { 7303 // Convert the reqd_work_group_size() attributes to metadata. 7304 llvm::LLVMContext &Context = F->getContext(); 7305 llvm::NamedMDNode *OpenCLMetadata = 7306 M.getModule().getOrInsertNamedMetadata( 7307 "opencl.kernel_wg_size_info"); 7308 7309 SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 5> Operands; 7310 Operands.push_back(llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(F)); 7311 7312 Operands.push_back( 7313 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue( 7314 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getXDim())))); 7315 Operands.push_back( 7316 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue( 7317 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getYDim())))); 7318 Operands.push_back( 7319 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue( 7320 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getZDim())))); 7321 7322 // Add a boolean constant operand for "required" (true) or "hint" 7323 // (false) for implementing the work_group_size_hint attr later. 7324 // Currently always true as the hint is not yet implemented. 7325 Operands.push_back( 7326 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::ConstantInt::getTrue(Context))); 7327 OpenCLMetadata->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Context, Operands)); 7328 } 7329 } 7330 } 7331 } 7332 7333 } 7334 7335 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7336 // Hexagon ABI Implementation 7337 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7338 7339 namespace { 7340 7341 class HexagonABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 7342 7343 7344 public: 7345 HexagonABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 7346 7347 private: 7348 7349 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 7350 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 7351 7352 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 7353 7354 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7355 QualType Ty) const override; 7356 }; 7357 7358 class HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7359 public: 7360 HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7361 :TargetCodeGenInfo(new HexagonABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7362 7363 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 7364 return 29; 7365 } 7366 }; 7367 7368 } 7369 7370 void HexagonABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 7371 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 7372 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 7373 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 7374 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 7375 } 7376 7377 ABIArgInfo HexagonABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 7378 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 7379 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 7380 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 7381 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7382 7383 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty) 7384 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 7385 } 7386 7387 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 7388 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 7389 7390 // Ignore empty records. 7391 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 7392 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7393 7394 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 7395 if (Size > 64) 7396 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true); 7397 // Pass in the smallest viable integer type. 7398 else if (Size > 32) 7399 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext())); 7400 else if (Size > 16) 7401 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 7402 else if (Size > 8) 7403 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 7404 else 7405 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 7406 } 7407 7408 ABIArgInfo HexagonABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 7409 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 7410 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7411 7412 // Large vector types should be returned via memory. 7413 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 64) 7414 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 7415 7416 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 7417 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 7418 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 7419 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7420 7421 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy) 7422 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 7423 } 7424 7425 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 7426 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7427 7428 // Aggregates <= 8 bytes are returned in r0; other aggregates 7429 // are returned indirectly. 7430 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 7431 if (Size <= 64) { 7432 // Return in the smallest viable integer type. 7433 if (Size <= 8) 7434 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 7435 if (Size <= 16) 7436 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 7437 if (Size <= 32) 7438 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 7439 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext())); 7440 } 7441 7442 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/true); 7443 } 7444 7445 Address HexagonABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7446 QualType Ty) const { 7447 // FIXME: Someone needs to audit that this handle alignment correctly. 7448 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 7449 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 7450 CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 7451 /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 7452 } 7453 7454 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7455 // Lanai ABI Implementation 7456 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7457 7458 namespace { 7459 class LanaiABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 7460 public: 7461 LanaiABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 7462 7463 bool shouldUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 7464 7465 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 7466 CCState State(FI.getCallingConvention()); 7467 // Lanai uses 4 registers to pass arguments unless the function has the 7468 // regparm attribute set. 7469 if (FI.getHasRegParm()) { 7470 State.FreeRegs = FI.getRegParm(); 7471 } else { 7472 State.FreeRegs = 4; 7473 } 7474 7475 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 7476 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 7477 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 7478 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State); 7479 } 7480 7481 ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, CCState &State) const; 7482 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const; 7483 }; 7484 } // end anonymous namespace 7485 7486 bool LanaiABIInfo::shouldUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const { 7487 unsigned Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 7488 unsigned SizeInRegs = llvm::alignTo(Size, 32U) / 32U; 7489 7490 if (SizeInRegs == 0) 7491 return false; 7492 7493 if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs) { 7494 State.FreeRegs = 0; 7495 return false; 7496 } 7497 7498 State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs; 7499 7500 return true; 7501 } 7502 7503 ABIArgInfo LanaiABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, 7504 CCState &State) const { 7505 if (!ByVal) { 7506 if (State.FreeRegs) { 7507 --State.FreeRegs; // Non-byval indirects just use one pointer. 7508 return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty); 7509 } 7510 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false); 7511 } 7512 7513 // Compute the byval alignment. 7514 const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4; 7515 unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 7516 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true, 7517 /*Realign=*/TypeAlign > 7518 MinABIStackAlignInBytes); 7519 } 7520 7521 ABIArgInfo LanaiABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 7522 CCState &State) const { 7523 // Check with the C++ ABI first. 7524 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 7525 if (RT) { 7526 CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()); 7527 if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) { 7528 return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State); 7529 } else if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) { 7530 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByRef=*/true); 7531 } 7532 } 7533 7534 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 7535 // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect. 7536 if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 7537 return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true, State); 7538 7539 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 7540 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 7541 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7542 7543 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext(); 7544 unsigned SizeInRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 7545 if (SizeInRegs <= State.FreeRegs) { 7546 llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext); 7547 SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32); 7548 llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements); 7549 State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs; 7550 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result); 7551 } else { 7552 State.FreeRegs = 0; 7553 } 7554 return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State); 7555 } 7556 7557 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 7558 if (const auto *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 7559 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7560 7561 bool InReg = shouldUseInReg(Ty, State); 7562 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 7563 if (InReg) 7564 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(); 7565 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty); 7566 } 7567 if (InReg) 7568 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(); 7569 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7570 } 7571 7572 namespace { 7573 class LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7574 public: 7575 LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7576 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new LanaiABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7577 }; 7578 } 7579 7580 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7581 // AMDGPU ABI Implementation 7582 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7583 7584 namespace { 7585 7586 class AMDGPUABIInfo final : public DefaultABIInfo { 7587 private: 7588 static const unsigned MaxNumRegsForArgsRet = 16; 7589 7590 unsigned numRegsForType(QualType Ty) const; 7591 7592 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override; 7593 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base, 7594 uint64_t Members) const override; 7595 7596 public: 7597 explicit AMDGPUABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : 7598 DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 7599 7600 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 7601 ABIArgInfo classifyKernelArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 7602 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, unsigned &NumRegsLeft) const; 7603 7604 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 7605 }; 7606 7607 bool AMDGPUABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 7608 return true; 7609 } 7610 7611 bool AMDGPUABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough( 7612 const Type *Base, uint64_t Members) const { 7613 uint32_t NumRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) + 31) / 32; 7614 7615 // Homogeneous Aggregates may occupy at most 16 registers. 7616 return Members * NumRegs <= MaxNumRegsForArgsRet; 7617 } 7618 7619 /// Estimate number of registers the type will use when passed in registers. 7620 unsigned AMDGPUABIInfo::numRegsForType(QualType Ty) const { 7621 unsigned NumRegs = 0; 7622 7623 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 7624 // Compute from the number of elements. The reported size is based on the 7625 // in-memory size, which includes the padding 4th element for 3-vectors. 7626 QualType EltTy = VT->getElementType(); 7627 unsigned EltSize = getContext().getTypeSize(EltTy); 7628 7629 // 16-bit element vectors should be passed as packed. 7630 if (EltSize == 16) 7631 return (VT->getNumElements() + 1) / 2; 7632 7633 unsigned EltNumRegs = (EltSize + 31) / 32; 7634 return EltNumRegs * VT->getNumElements(); 7635 } 7636 7637 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 7638 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 7639 assert(!RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()); 7640 7641 for (const FieldDecl *Field : RD->fields()) { 7642 QualType FieldTy = Field->getType(); 7643 NumRegs += numRegsForType(FieldTy); 7644 } 7645 7646 return NumRegs; 7647 } 7648 7649 return (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 7650 } 7651 7652 void AMDGPUABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 7653 llvm::CallingConv::ID CC = FI.getCallingConvention(); 7654 7655 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 7656 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 7657 7658 unsigned NumRegsLeft = MaxNumRegsForArgsRet; 7659 for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments()) { 7660 if (CC == llvm::CallingConv::AMDGPU_KERNEL) { 7661 Arg.info = classifyKernelArgumentType(Arg.type); 7662 } else { 7663 Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type, NumRegsLeft); 7664 } 7665 } 7666 } 7667 7668 ABIArgInfo AMDGPUABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 7669 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 7670 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 7671 // returned by value. 7672 if (!getRecordArgABI(RetTy, getCXXABI())) { 7673 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 7674 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 7675 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7676 7677 // Lower single-element structs to just return a regular value. 7678 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext())) 7679 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 7680 7681 if (const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 7682 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 7683 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 7684 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy); 7685 } 7686 7687 // Pack aggregates <= 4 bytes into single VGPR or pair. 7688 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 7689 if (Size <= 16) 7690 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 7691 7692 if (Size <= 32) 7693 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 7694 7695 if (Size <= 64) { 7696 llvm::Type *I32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 7697 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(I32Ty, 2)); 7698 } 7699 7700 if (numRegsForType(RetTy) <= MaxNumRegsForArgsRet) 7701 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7702 } 7703 } 7704 7705 // Otherwise just do the default thing. 7706 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy); 7707 } 7708 7709 /// For kernels all parameters are really passed in a special buffer. It doesn't 7710 /// make sense to pass anything byval, so everything must be direct. 7711 ABIArgInfo AMDGPUABIInfo::classifyKernelArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 7712 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 7713 7714 // TODO: Can we omit empty structs? 7715 7716 // Coerce single element structs to its element. 7717 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext())) 7718 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 7719 7720 // If we set CanBeFlattened to true, CodeGen will expand the struct to its 7721 // individual elements, which confuses the Clover OpenCL backend; therefore we 7722 // have to set it to false here. Other args of getDirect() are just defaults. 7723 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false); 7724 } 7725 7726 ABIArgInfo AMDGPUABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 7727 unsigned &NumRegsLeft) const { 7728 assert(NumRegsLeft <= MaxNumRegsForArgsRet && "register estimate underflow"); 7729 7730 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 7731 7732 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 7733 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 7734 // passed by value. 7735 if (auto RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 7736 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 7737 7738 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 7739 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 7740 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7741 7742 // Lower single-element structs to just pass a regular value. TODO: We 7743 // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using getExpand(), 7744 // though watch out for things like bitfields. 7745 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext())) 7746 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 7747 7748 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 7749 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 7750 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 7751 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty); 7752 } 7753 7754 // Pack aggregates <= 8 bytes into single VGPR or pair. 7755 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 7756 if (Size <= 64) { 7757 unsigned NumRegs = (Size + 31) / 32; 7758 NumRegsLeft -= std::min(NumRegsLeft, NumRegs); 7759 7760 if (Size <= 16) 7761 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 7762 7763 if (Size <= 32) 7764 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 7765 7766 // XXX: Should this be i64 instead, and should the limit increase? 7767 llvm::Type *I32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 7768 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(I32Ty, 2)); 7769 } 7770 7771 if (NumRegsLeft > 0) { 7772 unsigned NumRegs = numRegsForType(Ty); 7773 if (NumRegsLeft >= NumRegs) { 7774 NumRegsLeft -= NumRegs; 7775 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7776 } 7777 } 7778 } 7779 7780 // Otherwise just do the default thing. 7781 ABIArgInfo ArgInfo = DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty); 7782 if (!ArgInfo.isIndirect()) { 7783 unsigned NumRegs = numRegsForType(Ty); 7784 NumRegsLeft -= std::min(NumRegs, NumRegsLeft); 7785 } 7786 7787 return ArgInfo; 7788 } 7789 7790 class AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7791 public: 7792 AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7793 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new AMDGPUABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7794 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 7795 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 7796 unsigned getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const override; 7797 7798 llvm::Constant *getNullPointer(const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 7799 llvm::PointerType *T, QualType QT) const override; 7800 7801 LangAS getASTAllocaAddressSpace() const override { 7802 return getLangASFromTargetAS( 7803 getABIInfo().getDataLayout().getAllocaAddrSpace()); 7804 } 7805 LangAS getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM, 7806 const VarDecl *D) const override; 7807 llvm::SyncScope::ID getLLVMSyncScopeID(SyncScope S, 7808 llvm::LLVMContext &C) const override; 7809 llvm::Function * 7810 createEnqueuedBlockKernel(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 7811 llvm::Function *BlockInvokeFunc, 7812 llvm::Value *BlockLiteral) const override; 7813 bool shouldEmitStaticExternCAliases() const override; 7814 void setCUDAKernelCallingConvention(const FunctionType *&FT) const override; 7815 }; 7816 } 7817 7818 static bool requiresAMDGPUProtectedVisibility(const Decl *D, 7819 llvm::GlobalValue *GV) { 7820 if (GV->getVisibility() != llvm::GlobalValue::HiddenVisibility) 7821 return false; 7822 7823 return D->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>() || 7824 (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) || 7825 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>()); 7826 } 7827 7828 void AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 7829 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const { 7830 if (requiresAMDGPUProtectedVisibility(D, GV)) { 7831 GV->setVisibility(llvm::GlobalValue::ProtectedVisibility); 7832 GV->setDSOLocal(true); 7833 } 7834 7835 if (GV->isDeclaration()) 7836 return; 7837 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 7838 if (!FD) 7839 return; 7840 7841 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 7842 7843 const auto *ReqdWGS = M.getLangOpts().OpenCL ? 7844 FD->getAttr<ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr>() : nullptr; 7845 7846 if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL && FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>() && 7847 (M.getTriple().getOS() == llvm::Triple::AMDHSA)) 7848 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-implicitarg-num-bytes", "48"); 7849 7850 const auto *FlatWGS = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUFlatWorkGroupSizeAttr>(); 7851 if (ReqdWGS || FlatWGS) { 7852 unsigned Min = 0; 7853 unsigned Max = 0; 7854 if (FlatWGS) { 7855 Min = FlatWGS->getMin() 7856 ->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()) 7857 .getExtValue(); 7858 Max = FlatWGS->getMax() 7859 ->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()) 7860 .getExtValue(); 7861 } 7862 if (ReqdWGS && Min == 0 && Max == 0) 7863 Min = Max = ReqdWGS->getXDim() * ReqdWGS->getYDim() * ReqdWGS->getZDim(); 7864 7865 if (Min != 0) { 7866 assert(Min <= Max && "Min must be less than or equal Max"); 7867 7868 std::string AttrVal = llvm::utostr(Min) + "," + llvm::utostr(Max); 7869 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-flat-work-group-size", AttrVal); 7870 } else 7871 assert(Max == 0 && "Max must be zero"); 7872 } 7873 7874 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUWavesPerEUAttr>()) { 7875 unsigned Min = 7876 Attr->getMin()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()).getExtValue(); 7877 unsigned Max = Attr->getMax() ? Attr->getMax() 7878 ->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()) 7879 .getExtValue() 7880 : 0; 7881 7882 if (Min != 0) { 7883 assert((Max == 0 || Min <= Max) && "Min must be less than or equal Max"); 7884 7885 std::string AttrVal = llvm::utostr(Min); 7886 if (Max != 0) 7887 AttrVal = AttrVal + "," + llvm::utostr(Max); 7888 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-waves-per-eu", AttrVal); 7889 } else 7890 assert(Max == 0 && "Max must be zero"); 7891 } 7892 7893 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUNumSGPRAttr>()) { 7894 unsigned NumSGPR = Attr->getNumSGPR(); 7895 7896 if (NumSGPR != 0) 7897 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-num-sgpr", llvm::utostr(NumSGPR)); 7898 } 7899 7900 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUNumVGPRAttr>()) { 7901 uint32_t NumVGPR = Attr->getNumVGPR(); 7902 7903 if (NumVGPR != 0) 7904 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-num-vgpr", llvm::utostr(NumVGPR)); 7905 } 7906 } 7907 7908 unsigned AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const { 7909 return llvm::CallingConv::AMDGPU_KERNEL; 7910 } 7911 7912 // Currently LLVM assumes null pointers always have value 0, 7913 // which results in incorrectly transformed IR. Therefore, instead of 7914 // emitting null pointers in private and local address spaces, a null 7915 // pointer in generic address space is emitted which is casted to a 7916 // pointer in local or private address space. 7917 llvm::Constant *AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getNullPointer( 7918 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, llvm::PointerType *PT, 7919 QualType QT) const { 7920 if (CGM.getContext().getTargetNullPointerValue(QT) == 0) 7921 return llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(PT); 7922 7923 auto &Ctx = CGM.getContext(); 7924 auto NPT = llvm::PointerType::get(PT->getElementType(), 7925 Ctx.getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_generic)); 7926 return llvm::ConstantExpr::getAddrSpaceCast( 7927 llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(NPT), PT); 7928 } 7929 7930 LangAS 7931 AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM, 7932 const VarDecl *D) const { 7933 assert(!CGM.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 7934 !(CGM.getLangOpts().CUDA && CGM.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) && 7935 "Address space agnostic languages only"); 7936 LangAS DefaultGlobalAS = getLangASFromTargetAS( 7937 CGM.getContext().getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global)); 7938 if (!D) 7939 return DefaultGlobalAS; 7940 7941 LangAS AddrSpace = D->getType().getAddressSpace(); 7942 assert(AddrSpace == LangAS::Default || isTargetAddressSpace(AddrSpace)); 7943 if (AddrSpace != LangAS::Default) 7944 return AddrSpace; 7945 7946 if (CGM.isTypeConstant(D->getType(), false)) { 7947 if (auto ConstAS = CGM.getTarget().getConstantAddressSpace()) 7948 return ConstAS.getValue(); 7949 } 7950 return DefaultGlobalAS; 7951 } 7952 7953 llvm::SyncScope::ID 7954 AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getLLVMSyncScopeID(SyncScope S, 7955 llvm::LLVMContext &C) const { 7956 StringRef Name; 7957 switch (S) { 7958 case SyncScope::OpenCLWorkGroup: 7959 Name = "workgroup"; 7960 break; 7961 case SyncScope::OpenCLDevice: 7962 Name = "agent"; 7963 break; 7964 case SyncScope::OpenCLAllSVMDevices: 7965 Name = ""; 7966 break; 7967 case SyncScope::OpenCLSubGroup: 7968 Name = "wavefront"; 7969 } 7970 return C.getOrInsertSyncScopeID(Name); 7971 } 7972 7973 bool AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::shouldEmitStaticExternCAliases() const { 7974 return false; 7975 } 7976 7977 void AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::setCUDAKernelCallingConvention( 7978 const FunctionType *&FT) const { 7979 FT = getABIInfo().getContext().adjustFunctionType( 7980 FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_OpenCLKernel)); 7981 } 7982 7983 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7984 // SPARC v8 ABI Implementation. 7985 // Based on the SPARC Compliance Definition version 2.4.1. 7986 // 7987 // Ensures that complex values are passed in registers. 7988 // 7989 namespace { 7990 class SparcV8ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 7991 public: 7992 SparcV8ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 7993 7994 private: 7995 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 7996 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 7997 }; 7998 } // end anonymous namespace 7999 8000 8001 ABIArgInfo 8002 SparcV8ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType Ty) const { 8003 if (Ty->isAnyComplexType()) { 8004 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 8005 } 8006 else { 8007 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(Ty); 8008 } 8009 } 8010 8011 void SparcV8ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 8012 8013 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 8014 for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments()) 8015 Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type); 8016 } 8017 8018 namespace { 8019 class SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 8020 public: 8021 SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 8022 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SparcV8ABIInfo(CGT)) {} 8023 }; 8024 } // end anonymous namespace 8025 8026 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8027 // SPARC v9 ABI Implementation. 8028 // Based on the SPARC Compliance Definition version 2.4.1. 8029 // 8030 // Function arguments a mapped to a nominal "parameter array" and promoted to 8031 // registers depending on their type. Each argument occupies 8 or 16 bytes in 8032 // the array, structs larger than 16 bytes are passed indirectly. 8033 // 8034 // One case requires special care: 8035 // 8036 // struct mixed { 8037 // int i; 8038 // float f; 8039 // }; 8040 // 8041 // When a struct mixed is passed by value, it only occupies 8 bytes in the 8042 // parameter array, but the int is passed in an integer register, and the float 8043 // is passed in a floating point register. This is represented as two arguments 8044 // with the LLVM IR inreg attribute: 8045 // 8046 // declare void f(i32 inreg %i, float inreg %f) 8047 // 8048 // The code generator will only allocate 4 bytes from the parameter array for 8049 // the inreg arguments. All other arguments are allocated a multiple of 8 8050 // bytes. 8051 // 8052 namespace { 8053 class SparcV9ABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 8054 public: 8055 SparcV9ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 8056 8057 private: 8058 ABIArgInfo classifyType(QualType RetTy, unsigned SizeLimit) const; 8059 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 8060 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 8061 QualType Ty) const override; 8062 8063 // Coercion type builder for structs passed in registers. The coercion type 8064 // serves two purposes: 8065 // 8066 // 1. Pad structs to a multiple of 64 bits, so they are passed 'left-aligned' 8067 // in registers. 8068 // 2. Expose aligned floating point elements as first-level elements, so the 8069 // code generator knows to pass them in floating point registers. 8070 // 8071 // We also compute the InReg flag which indicates that the struct contains 8072 // aligned 32-bit floats. 8073 // 8074 struct CoerceBuilder { 8075 llvm::LLVMContext &Context; 8076 const llvm::DataLayout &DL; 8077 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> Elems; 8078 uint64_t Size; 8079 bool InReg; 8080 8081 CoerceBuilder(llvm::LLVMContext &c, const llvm::DataLayout &dl) 8082 : Context(c), DL(dl), Size(0), InReg(false) {} 8083 8084 // Pad Elems with integers until Size is ToSize. 8085 void pad(uint64_t ToSize) { 8086 assert(ToSize >= Size && "Cannot remove elements"); 8087 if (ToSize == Size) 8088 return; 8089 8090 // Finish the current 64-bit word. 8091 uint64_t Aligned = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64); 8092 if (Aligned > Size && Aligned <= ToSize) { 8093 Elems.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(Context, Aligned - Size)); 8094 Size = Aligned; 8095 } 8096 8097 // Add whole 64-bit words. 8098 while (Size + 64 <= ToSize) { 8099 Elems.push_back(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(Context)); 8100 Size += 64; 8101 } 8102 8103 // Final in-word padding. 8104 if (Size < ToSize) { 8105 Elems.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(Context, ToSize - Size)); 8106 Size = ToSize; 8107 } 8108 } 8109 8110 // Add a floating point element at Offset. 8111 void addFloat(uint64_t Offset, llvm::Type *Ty, unsigned Bits) { 8112 // Unaligned floats are treated as integers. 8113 if (Offset % Bits) 8114 return; 8115 // The InReg flag is only required if there are any floats < 64 bits. 8116 if (Bits < 64) 8117 InReg = true; 8118 pad(Offset); 8119 Elems.push_back(Ty); 8120 Size = Offset + Bits; 8121 } 8122 8123 // Add a struct type to the coercion type, starting at Offset (in bits). 8124 void addStruct(uint64_t Offset, llvm::StructType *StrTy) { 8125 const llvm::StructLayout *Layout = DL.getStructLayout(StrTy); 8126 for (unsigned i = 0, e = StrTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) { 8127 llvm::Type *ElemTy = StrTy->getElementType(i); 8128 uint64_t ElemOffset = Offset + Layout->getElementOffsetInBits(i); 8129 switch (ElemTy->getTypeID()) { 8130 case llvm::Type::StructTyID: 8131 addStruct(ElemOffset, cast<llvm::StructType>(ElemTy)); 8132 break; 8133 case llvm::Type::FloatTyID: 8134 addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 32); 8135 break; 8136 case llvm::Type::DoubleTyID: 8137 addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 64); 8138 break; 8139 case llvm::Type::FP128TyID: 8140 addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 128); 8141 break; 8142 case llvm::Type::PointerTyID: 8143 if (ElemOffset % 64 == 0) { 8144 pad(ElemOffset); 8145 Elems.push_back(ElemTy); 8146 Size += 64; 8147 } 8148 break; 8149 default: 8150 break; 8151 } 8152 } 8153 } 8154 8155 // Check if Ty is a usable substitute for the coercion type. 8156 bool isUsableType(llvm::StructType *Ty) const { 8157 return llvm::makeArrayRef(Elems) == Ty->elements(); 8158 } 8159 8160 // Get the coercion type as a literal struct type. 8161 llvm::Type *getType() const { 8162 if (Elems.size() == 1) 8163 return Elems.front(); 8164 else 8165 return llvm::StructType::get(Context, Elems); 8166 } 8167 }; 8168 }; 8169 } // end anonymous namespace 8170 8171 ABIArgInfo 8172 SparcV9ABIInfo::classifyType(QualType Ty, unsigned SizeLimit) const { 8173 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 8174 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 8175 8176 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 8177 8178 // Anything too big to fit in registers is passed with an explicit indirect 8179 // pointer / sret pointer. 8180 if (Size > SizeLimit) 8181 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 8182 8183 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 8184 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 8185 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 8186 8187 // Integer types smaller than a register are extended. 8188 if (Size < 64 && Ty->isIntegerType()) 8189 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty); 8190 8191 // Other non-aggregates go in registers. 8192 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) 8193 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 8194 8195 // If a C++ object has either a non-trivial copy constructor or a non-trivial 8196 // destructor, it is passed with an explicit indirect pointer / sret pointer. 8197 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 8198 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 8199 8200 // This is a small aggregate type that should be passed in registers. 8201 // Build a coercion type from the LLVM struct type. 8202 llvm::StructType *StrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(CGT.ConvertType(Ty)); 8203 if (!StrTy) 8204 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 8205 8206 CoerceBuilder CB(getVMContext(), getDataLayout()); 8207 CB.addStruct(0, StrTy); 8208 CB.pad(llvm::alignTo(CB.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StrTy), 64)); 8209 8210 // Try to use the original type for coercion. 8211 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = CB.isUsableType(StrTy) ? StrTy : CB.getType(); 8212 8213 if (CB.InReg) 8214 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(CoerceTy); 8215 else 8216 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 8217 } 8218 8219 Address SparcV9ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 8220 QualType Ty) const { 8221 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyType(Ty, 16 * 8); 8222 llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 8223 if (AI.canHaveCoerceToType() && !AI.getCoerceToType()) 8224 AI.setCoerceToType(ArgTy); 8225 8226 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 8227 8228 CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 8229 Address Addr(Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "ap.cur"), SlotSize); 8230 llvm::Type *ArgPtrTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(ArgTy); 8231 8232 auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 8233 8234 Address ArgAddr = Address::invalid(); 8235 CharUnits Stride; 8236 switch (AI.getKind()) { 8237 case ABIArgInfo::Expand: 8238 case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand: 8239 case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca: 8240 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI kind for va_arg"); 8241 8242 case ABIArgInfo::Extend: { 8243 Stride = SlotSize; 8244 CharUnits Offset = SlotSize - TypeInfo.first; 8245 ArgAddr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, Offset, "extend"); 8246 break; 8247 } 8248 8249 case ABIArgInfo::Direct: { 8250 auto AllocSize = getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AI.getCoerceToType()); 8251 Stride = CharUnits::fromQuantity(AllocSize).alignTo(SlotSize); 8252 ArgAddr = Addr; 8253 break; 8254 } 8255 8256 case ABIArgInfo::Indirect: 8257 Stride = SlotSize; 8258 ArgAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, ArgPtrTy, "indirect"); 8259 ArgAddr = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(ArgAddr, "indirect.arg"), 8260 TypeInfo.second); 8261 break; 8262 8263 case ABIArgInfo::Ignore: 8264 return Address(llvm::UndefValue::get(ArgPtrTy), TypeInfo.second); 8265 } 8266 8267 // Update VAList. 8268 Address NextPtr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, Stride, "ap.next"); 8269 Builder.CreateStore(NextPtr.getPointer(), VAListAddr); 8270 8271 return Builder.CreateBitCast(ArgAddr, ArgPtrTy, "arg.addr"); 8272 } 8273 8274 void SparcV9ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 8275 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyType(FI.getReturnType(), 32 * 8); 8276 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 8277 I.info = classifyType(I.type, 16 * 8); 8278 } 8279 8280 namespace { 8281 class SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 8282 public: 8283 SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 8284 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SparcV9ABIInfo(CGT)) {} 8285 8286 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 8287 return 14; 8288 } 8289 8290 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 8291 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 8292 }; 8293 } // end anonymous namespace 8294 8295 bool 8296 SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 8297 llvm::Value *Address) const { 8298 // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified 8299 // against gcc output. AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding. 8300 8301 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 8302 8303 llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty; 8304 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4); 8305 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8); 8306 8307 // 0-31: the 8-byte general-purpose registers 8308 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 31); 8309 8310 // 32-63: f0-31, the 4-byte floating-point registers 8311 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 32, 63); 8312 8313 // Y = 64 8314 // PSR = 65 8315 // WIM = 66 8316 // TBR = 67 8317 // PC = 68 8318 // NPC = 69 8319 // FSR = 70 8320 // CSR = 71 8321 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 64, 71); 8322 8323 // 72-87: d0-15, the 8-byte floating-point registers 8324 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 72, 87); 8325 8326 return false; 8327 } 8328 8329 // ARC ABI implementation. 8330 namespace { 8331 8332 class ARCABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 8333 public: 8334 using DefaultABIInfo::DefaultABIInfo; 8335 8336 private: 8337 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 8338 QualType Ty) const override; 8339 8340 void updateState(const ABIArgInfo &Info, QualType Ty, CCState &State) const { 8341 if (!State.FreeRegs) 8342 return; 8343 if (Info.isIndirect() && Info.getInReg()) 8344 State.FreeRegs--; 8345 else if (Info.isDirect() && Info.getInReg()) { 8346 unsigned sz = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 8347 if (sz < State.FreeRegs) 8348 State.FreeRegs -= sz; 8349 else 8350 State.FreeRegs = 0; 8351 } 8352 } 8353 8354 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 8355 CCState State(FI.getCallingConvention()); 8356 // ARC uses 8 registers to pass arguments. 8357 State.FreeRegs = 8; 8358 8359 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 8360 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 8361 updateState(FI.getReturnInfo(), FI.getReturnType(), State); 8362 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 8363 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State.FreeRegs); 8364 updateState(I.info, I.type, State); 8365 } 8366 } 8367 8368 ABIArgInfo getIndirectByRef(QualType Ty, bool HasFreeRegs) const; 8369 ABIArgInfo getIndirectByValue(QualType Ty) const; 8370 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, uint8_t FreeRegs) const; 8371 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 8372 }; 8373 8374 class ARCTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 8375 public: 8376 ARCTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 8377 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new ARCABIInfo(CGT)) {} 8378 }; 8379 8380 8381 ABIArgInfo ARCABIInfo::getIndirectByRef(QualType Ty, bool HasFreeRegs) const { 8382 return HasFreeRegs ? getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty) : 8383 getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false); 8384 } 8385 8386 ABIArgInfo ARCABIInfo::getIndirectByValue(QualType Ty) const { 8387 // Compute the byval alignment. 8388 const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4; 8389 unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 8390 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true, 8391 TypeAlign > MinABIStackAlignInBytes); 8392 } 8393 8394 Address ARCABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 8395 QualType Ty) const { 8396 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 8397 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 8398 CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), true); 8399 } 8400 8401 ABIArgInfo ARCABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 8402 uint8_t FreeRegs) const { 8403 // Handle the generic C++ ABI. 8404 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 8405 if (RT) { 8406 CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()); 8407 if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) 8408 return getIndirectByRef(Ty, FreeRegs > 0); 8409 8410 if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) 8411 return getIndirectByValue(Ty); 8412 } 8413 8414 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 8415 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 8416 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 8417 8418 auto SizeInRegs = llvm::alignTo(getContext().getTypeSize(Ty), 32) / 32; 8419 8420 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 8421 // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect. 8422 if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 8423 return getIndirectByValue(Ty); 8424 8425 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 8426 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 8427 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 8428 8429 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext(); 8430 8431 llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext); 8432 SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32); 8433 llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements); 8434 8435 return FreeRegs >= SizeInRegs ? 8436 ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result) : 8437 ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Result, 0, nullptr, false); 8438 } 8439 8440 return Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 8441 (FreeRegs >= SizeInRegs ? ABIArgInfo::getExtendInReg(Ty) : 8442 ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)) : 8443 (FreeRegs >= SizeInRegs ? ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg() : 8444 ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 8445 } 8446 8447 ABIArgInfo ARCABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 8448 if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 8449 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(); 8450 8451 // Arguments of size > 4 registers are indirect. 8452 auto RetSize = llvm::alignTo(getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy), 32) / 32; 8453 if (RetSize > 4) 8454 return getIndirectByRef(RetTy, /*HasFreeRegs*/ true); 8455 8456 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy); 8457 } 8458 8459 } // End anonymous namespace. 8460 8461 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8462 // XCore ABI Implementation 8463 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8464 8465 namespace { 8466 8467 /// A SmallStringEnc instance is used to build up the TypeString by passing 8468 /// it by reference between functions that append to it. 8469 typedef llvm::SmallString<128> SmallStringEnc; 8470 8471 /// TypeStringCache caches the meta encodings of Types. 8472 /// 8473 /// The reason for caching TypeStrings is two fold: 8474 /// 1. To cache a type's encoding for later uses; 8475 /// 2. As a means to break recursive member type inclusion. 8476 /// 8477 /// A cache Entry can have a Status of: 8478 /// NonRecursive: The type encoding is not recursive; 8479 /// Recursive: The type encoding is recursive; 8480 /// Incomplete: An incomplete TypeString; 8481 /// IncompleteUsed: An incomplete TypeString that has been used in a 8482 /// Recursive type encoding. 8483 /// 8484 /// A NonRecursive entry will have all of its sub-members expanded as fully 8485 /// as possible. Whilst it may contain types which are recursive, the type 8486 /// itself is not recursive and thus its encoding may be safely used whenever 8487 /// the type is encountered. 8488 /// 8489 /// A Recursive entry will have all of its sub-members expanded as fully as 8490 /// possible. The type itself is recursive and it may contain other types which 8491 /// are recursive. The Recursive encoding must not be used during the expansion 8492 /// of a recursive type's recursive branch. For simplicity the code uses 8493 /// IncompleteCount to reject all usage of Recursive encodings for member types. 8494 /// 8495 /// An Incomplete entry is always a RecordType and only encodes its 8496 /// identifier e.g. "s(S){}". Incomplete 'StubEnc' entries are ephemeral and 8497 /// are placed into the cache during type expansion as a means to identify and 8498 /// handle recursive inclusion of types as sub-members. If there is recursion 8499 /// the entry becomes IncompleteUsed. 8500 /// 8501 /// During the expansion of a RecordType's members: 8502 /// 8503 /// If the cache contains a NonRecursive encoding for the member type, the 8504 /// cached encoding is used; 8505 /// 8506 /// If the cache contains a Recursive encoding for the member type, the 8507 /// cached encoding is 'Swapped' out, as it may be incorrect, and... 8508 /// 8509 /// If the member is a RecordType, an Incomplete encoding is placed into the 8510 /// cache to break potential recursive inclusion of itself as a sub-member; 8511 /// 8512 /// Once a member RecordType has been expanded, its temporary incomplete 8513 /// entry is removed from the cache. If a Recursive encoding was swapped out 8514 /// it is swapped back in; 8515 /// 8516 /// If an incomplete entry is used to expand a sub-member, the incomplete 8517 /// entry is marked as IncompleteUsed. The cache keeps count of how many 8518 /// IncompleteUsed entries it currently contains in IncompleteUsedCount; 8519 /// 8520 /// If a member's encoding is found to be a NonRecursive or Recursive viz: 8521 /// IncompleteUsedCount==0, the member's encoding is added to the cache. 8522 /// Else the member is part of a recursive type and thus the recursion has 8523 /// been exited too soon for the encoding to be correct for the member. 8524 /// 8525 class TypeStringCache { 8526 enum Status {NonRecursive, Recursive, Incomplete, IncompleteUsed}; 8527 struct Entry { 8528 std::string Str; // The encoded TypeString for the type. 8529 enum Status State; // Information about the encoding in 'Str'. 8530 std::string Swapped; // A temporary place holder for a Recursive encoding 8531 // during the expansion of RecordType's members. 8532 }; 8533 std::map<const IdentifierInfo *, struct Entry> Map; 8534 unsigned IncompleteCount; // Number of Incomplete entries in the Map. 8535 unsigned IncompleteUsedCount; // Number of IncompleteUsed entries in the Map. 8536 public: 8537 TypeStringCache() : IncompleteCount(0), IncompleteUsedCount(0) {} 8538 void addIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, std::string StubEnc); 8539 bool removeIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID); 8540 void addIfComplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, StringRef Str, 8541 bool IsRecursive); 8542 StringRef lookupStr(const IdentifierInfo *ID); 8543 }; 8544 8545 /// TypeString encodings for enum & union fields must be order. 8546 /// FieldEncoding is a helper for this ordering process. 8547 class FieldEncoding { 8548 bool HasName; 8549 std::string Enc; 8550 public: 8551 FieldEncoding(bool b, SmallStringEnc &e) : HasName(b), Enc(e.c_str()) {} 8552 StringRef str() { return Enc; } 8553 bool operator<(const FieldEncoding &rhs) const { 8554 if (HasName != rhs.HasName) return HasName; 8555 return Enc < rhs.Enc; 8556 } 8557 }; 8558 8559 class XCoreABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 8560 public: 8561 XCoreABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 8562 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 8563 QualType Ty) const override; 8564 }; 8565 8566 class XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 8567 mutable TypeStringCache TSC; 8568 public: 8569 XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 8570 :TargetCodeGenInfo(new XCoreABIInfo(CGT)) {} 8571 void emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 8572 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 8573 }; 8574 8575 } // End anonymous namespace. 8576 8577 // TODO: this implementation is likely now redundant with the default 8578 // EmitVAArg. 8579 Address XCoreABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 8580 QualType Ty) const { 8581 CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 8582 8583 // Get the VAList. 8584 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 8585 Address AP(Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize); 8586 8587 // Handle the argument. 8588 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty); 8589 CharUnits TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty); 8590 llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 8591 if (AI.canHaveCoerceToType() && !AI.getCoerceToType()) 8592 AI.setCoerceToType(ArgTy); 8593 llvm::Type *ArgPtrTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(ArgTy); 8594 8595 Address Val = Address::invalid(); 8596 CharUnits ArgSize = CharUnits::Zero(); 8597 switch (AI.getKind()) { 8598 case ABIArgInfo::Expand: 8599 case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand: 8600 case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca: 8601 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI kind for va_arg"); 8602 case ABIArgInfo::Ignore: 8603 Val = Address(llvm::UndefValue::get(ArgPtrTy), TypeAlign); 8604 ArgSize = CharUnits::Zero(); 8605 break; 8606 case ABIArgInfo::Extend: 8607 case ABIArgInfo::Direct: 8608 Val = Builder.CreateBitCast(AP, ArgPtrTy); 8609 ArgSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity( 8610 getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AI.getCoerceToType())); 8611 ArgSize = ArgSize.alignTo(SlotSize); 8612 break; 8613 case ABIArgInfo::Indirect: 8614 Val = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(AP, ArgPtrTy); 8615 Val = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(Val), TypeAlign); 8616 ArgSize = SlotSize; 8617 break; 8618 } 8619 8620 // Increment the VAList. 8621 if (!ArgSize.isZero()) { 8622 Address APN = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(AP, ArgSize); 8623 Builder.CreateStore(APN.getPointer(), VAListAddr); 8624 } 8625 8626 return Val; 8627 } 8628 8629 /// During the expansion of a RecordType, an incomplete TypeString is placed 8630 /// into the cache as a means to identify and break recursion. 8631 /// If there is a Recursive encoding in the cache, it is swapped out and will 8632 /// be reinserted by removeIncomplete(). 8633 /// All other types of encoding should have been used rather than arriving here. 8634 void TypeStringCache::addIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, 8635 std::string StubEnc) { 8636 if (!ID) 8637 return; 8638 Entry &E = Map[ID]; 8639 assert( (E.Str.empty() || E.State == Recursive) && 8640 "Incorrectly use of addIncomplete"); 8641 assert(!StubEnc.empty() && "Passing an empty string to addIncomplete()"); 8642 E.Swapped.swap(E.Str); // swap out the Recursive 8643 E.Str.swap(StubEnc); 8644 E.State = Incomplete; 8645 ++IncompleteCount; 8646 } 8647 8648 /// Once the RecordType has been expanded, the temporary incomplete TypeString 8649 /// must be removed from the cache. 8650 /// If a Recursive was swapped out by addIncomplete(), it will be replaced. 8651 /// Returns true if the RecordType was defined recursively. 8652 bool TypeStringCache::removeIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 8653 if (!ID) 8654 return false; 8655 auto I = Map.find(ID); 8656 assert(I != Map.end() && "Entry not present"); 8657 Entry &E = I->second; 8658 assert( (E.State == Incomplete || 8659 E.State == IncompleteUsed) && 8660 "Entry must be an incomplete type"); 8661 bool IsRecursive = false; 8662 if (E.State == IncompleteUsed) { 8663 // We made use of our Incomplete encoding, thus we are recursive. 8664 IsRecursive = true; 8665 --IncompleteUsedCount; 8666 } 8667 if (E.Swapped.empty()) 8668 Map.erase(I); 8669 else { 8670 // Swap the Recursive back. 8671 E.Swapped.swap(E.Str); 8672 E.Swapped.clear(); 8673 E.State = Recursive; 8674 } 8675 --IncompleteCount; 8676 return IsRecursive; 8677 } 8678 8679 /// Add the encoded TypeString to the cache only if it is NonRecursive or 8680 /// Recursive (viz: all sub-members were expanded as fully as possible). 8681 void TypeStringCache::addIfComplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, StringRef Str, 8682 bool IsRecursive) { 8683 if (!ID || IncompleteUsedCount) 8684 return; // No key or it is is an incomplete sub-type so don't add. 8685 Entry &E = Map[ID]; 8686 if (IsRecursive && !E.Str.empty()) { 8687 assert(E.State==Recursive && E.Str.size() == Str.size() && 8688 "This is not the same Recursive entry"); 8689 // The parent container was not recursive after all, so we could have used 8690 // this Recursive sub-member entry after all, but we assumed the worse when 8691 // we started viz: IncompleteCount!=0. 8692 return; 8693 } 8694 assert(E.Str.empty() && "Entry already present"); 8695 E.Str = Str.str(); 8696 E.State = IsRecursive? Recursive : NonRecursive; 8697 } 8698 8699 /// Return a cached TypeString encoding for the ID. If there isn't one, or we 8700 /// are recursively expanding a type (IncompleteCount != 0) and the cached 8701 /// encoding is Recursive, return an empty StringRef. 8702 StringRef TypeStringCache::lookupStr(const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 8703 if (!ID) 8704 return StringRef(); // We have no key. 8705 auto I = Map.find(ID); 8706 if (I == Map.end()) 8707 return StringRef(); // We have no encoding. 8708 Entry &E = I->second; 8709 if (E.State == Recursive && IncompleteCount) 8710 return StringRef(); // We don't use Recursive encodings for member types. 8711 8712 if (E.State == Incomplete) { 8713 // The incomplete type is being used to break out of recursion. 8714 E.State = IncompleteUsed; 8715 ++IncompleteUsedCount; 8716 } 8717 return E.Str; 8718 } 8719 8720 /// The XCore ABI includes a type information section that communicates symbol 8721 /// type information to the linker. The linker uses this information to verify 8722 /// safety/correctness of things such as array bound and pointers et al. 8723 /// The ABI only requires C (and XC) language modules to emit TypeStrings. 8724 /// This type information (TypeString) is emitted into meta data for all global 8725 /// symbols: definitions, declarations, functions & variables. 8726 /// 8727 /// The TypeString carries type, qualifier, name, size & value details. 8728 /// Please see 'Tools Development Guide' section 2.16.2 for format details: 8729 /// https://www.xmos.com/download/public/Tools-Development-Guide%28X9114A%29.pdf 8730 /// The output is tested by test/CodeGen/xcore-stringtype.c. 8731 /// 8732 static bool getTypeString(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const Decl *D, 8733 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, TypeStringCache &TSC); 8734 8735 /// XCore uses emitTargetMD to emit TypeString metadata for global symbols. 8736 void XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo::emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 8737 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 8738 SmallStringEnc Enc; 8739 if (getTypeString(Enc, D, CGM, TSC)) { 8740 llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = CGM.getModule().getContext(); 8741 llvm::Metadata *MDVals[] = {llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(GV), 8742 llvm::MDString::get(Ctx, Enc.str())}; 8743 llvm::NamedMDNode *MD = 8744 CGM.getModule().getOrInsertNamedMetadata("xcore.typestrings"); 8745 MD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, MDVals)); 8746 } 8747 } 8748 8749 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8750 // SPIR ABI Implementation 8751 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8752 8753 namespace { 8754 class SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 8755 public: 8756 SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 8757 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {} 8758 unsigned getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const override; 8759 }; 8760 8761 } // End anonymous namespace. 8762 8763 namespace clang { 8764 namespace CodeGen { 8765 void computeSPIRKernelABIInfo(CodeGenModule &CGM, CGFunctionInfo &FI) { 8766 DefaultABIInfo SPIRABI(CGM.getTypes()); 8767 SPIRABI.computeInfo(FI); 8768 } 8769 } 8770 } 8771 8772 unsigned SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const { 8773 return llvm::CallingConv::SPIR_KERNEL; 8774 } 8775 8776 static bool appendType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QType, 8777 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8778 TypeStringCache &TSC); 8779 8780 /// Helper function for appendRecordType(). 8781 /// Builds a SmallVector containing the encoded field types in declaration 8782 /// order. 8783 static bool extractFieldType(SmallVectorImpl<FieldEncoding> &FE, 8784 const RecordDecl *RD, 8785 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8786 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 8787 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) { 8788 SmallStringEnc Enc; 8789 Enc += "m("; 8790 Enc += Field->getName(); 8791 Enc += "){"; 8792 if (Field->isBitField()) { 8793 Enc += "b("; 8794 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Enc); 8795 OS << Field->getBitWidthValue(CGM.getContext()); 8796 Enc += ':'; 8797 } 8798 if (!appendType(Enc, Field->getType(), CGM, TSC)) 8799 return false; 8800 if (Field->isBitField()) 8801 Enc += ')'; 8802 Enc += '}'; 8803 FE.emplace_back(!Field->getName().empty(), Enc); 8804 } 8805 return true; 8806 } 8807 8808 /// Appends structure and union types to Enc and adds encoding to cache. 8809 /// Recursively calls appendType (via extractFieldType) for each field. 8810 /// Union types have their fields ordered according to the ABI. 8811 static bool appendRecordType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const RecordType *RT, 8812 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8813 TypeStringCache &TSC, const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 8814 // Append the cached TypeString if we have one. 8815 StringRef TypeString = TSC.lookupStr(ID); 8816 if (!TypeString.empty()) { 8817 Enc += TypeString; 8818 return true; 8819 } 8820 8821 // Start to emit an incomplete TypeString. 8822 size_t Start = Enc.size(); 8823 Enc += (RT->isUnionType()? 'u' : 's'); 8824 Enc += '('; 8825 if (ID) 8826 Enc += ID->getName(); 8827 Enc += "){"; 8828 8829 // We collect all encoded fields and order as necessary. 8830 bool IsRecursive = false; 8831 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl()->getDefinition(); 8832 if (RD && !RD->field_empty()) { 8833 // An incomplete TypeString stub is placed in the cache for this RecordType 8834 // so that recursive calls to this RecordType will use it whilst building a 8835 // complete TypeString for this RecordType. 8836 SmallVector<FieldEncoding, 16> FE; 8837 std::string StubEnc(Enc.substr(Start).str()); 8838 StubEnc += '}'; // StubEnc now holds a valid incomplete TypeString. 8839 TSC.addIncomplete(ID, std::move(StubEnc)); 8840 if (!extractFieldType(FE, RD, CGM, TSC)) { 8841 (void) TSC.removeIncomplete(ID); 8842 return false; 8843 } 8844 IsRecursive = TSC.removeIncomplete(ID); 8845 // The ABI requires unions to be sorted but not structures. 8846 // See FieldEncoding::operator< for sort algorithm. 8847 if (RT->isUnionType()) 8848 llvm::sort(FE); 8849 // We can now complete the TypeString. 8850 unsigned E = FE.size(); 8851 for (unsigned I = 0; I != E; ++I) { 8852 if (I) 8853 Enc += ','; 8854 Enc += FE[I].str(); 8855 } 8856 } 8857 Enc += '}'; 8858 TSC.addIfComplete(ID, Enc.substr(Start), IsRecursive); 8859 return true; 8860 } 8861 8862 /// Appends enum types to Enc and adds the encoding to the cache. 8863 static bool appendEnumType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const EnumType *ET, 8864 TypeStringCache &TSC, 8865 const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 8866 // Append the cached TypeString if we have one. 8867 StringRef TypeString = TSC.lookupStr(ID); 8868 if (!TypeString.empty()) { 8869 Enc += TypeString; 8870 return true; 8871 } 8872 8873 size_t Start = Enc.size(); 8874 Enc += "e("; 8875 if (ID) 8876 Enc += ID->getName(); 8877 Enc += "){"; 8878 8879 // We collect all encoded enumerations and order them alphanumerically. 8880 if (const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl()->getDefinition()) { 8881 SmallVector<FieldEncoding, 16> FE; 8882 for (auto I = ED->enumerator_begin(), E = ED->enumerator_end(); I != E; 8883 ++I) { 8884 SmallStringEnc EnumEnc; 8885 EnumEnc += "m("; 8886 EnumEnc += I->getName(); 8887 EnumEnc += "){"; 8888 I->getInitVal().toString(EnumEnc); 8889 EnumEnc += '}'; 8890 FE.push_back(FieldEncoding(!I->getName().empty(), EnumEnc)); 8891 } 8892 llvm::sort(FE); 8893 unsigned E = FE.size(); 8894 for (unsigned I = 0; I != E; ++I) { 8895 if (I) 8896 Enc += ','; 8897 Enc += FE[I].str(); 8898 } 8899 } 8900 Enc += '}'; 8901 TSC.addIfComplete(ID, Enc.substr(Start), false); 8902 return true; 8903 } 8904 8905 /// Appends type's qualifier to Enc. 8906 /// This is done prior to appending the type's encoding. 8907 static void appendQualifier(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QT) { 8908 // Qualifiers are emitted in alphabetical order. 8909 static const char *const Table[]={"","c:","r:","cr:","v:","cv:","rv:","crv:"}; 8910 int Lookup = 0; 8911 if (QT.isConstQualified()) 8912 Lookup += 1<<0; 8913 if (QT.isRestrictQualified()) 8914 Lookup += 1<<1; 8915 if (QT.isVolatileQualified()) 8916 Lookup += 1<<2; 8917 Enc += Table[Lookup]; 8918 } 8919 8920 /// Appends built-in types to Enc. 8921 static bool appendBuiltinType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const BuiltinType *BT) { 8922 const char *EncType; 8923 switch (BT->getKind()) { 8924 case BuiltinType::Void: 8925 EncType = "0"; 8926 break; 8927 case BuiltinType::Bool: 8928 EncType = "b"; 8929 break; 8930 case BuiltinType::Char_U: 8931 EncType = "uc"; 8932 break; 8933 case BuiltinType::UChar: 8934 EncType = "uc"; 8935 break; 8936 case BuiltinType::SChar: 8937 EncType = "sc"; 8938 break; 8939 case BuiltinType::UShort: 8940 EncType = "us"; 8941 break; 8942 case BuiltinType::Short: 8943 EncType = "ss"; 8944 break; 8945 case BuiltinType::UInt: 8946 EncType = "ui"; 8947 break; 8948 case BuiltinType::Int: 8949 EncType = "si"; 8950 break; 8951 case BuiltinType::ULong: 8952 EncType = "ul"; 8953 break; 8954 case BuiltinType::Long: 8955 EncType = "sl"; 8956 break; 8957 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: 8958 EncType = "ull"; 8959 break; 8960 case BuiltinType::LongLong: 8961 EncType = "sll"; 8962 break; 8963 case BuiltinType::Float: 8964 EncType = "ft"; 8965 break; 8966 case BuiltinType::Double: 8967 EncType = "d"; 8968 break; 8969 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: 8970 EncType = "ld"; 8971 break; 8972 default: 8973 return false; 8974 } 8975 Enc += EncType; 8976 return true; 8977 } 8978 8979 /// Appends a pointer encoding to Enc before calling appendType for the pointee. 8980 static bool appendPointerType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const PointerType *PT, 8981 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8982 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 8983 Enc += "p("; 8984 if (!appendType(Enc, PT->getPointeeType(), CGM, TSC)) 8985 return false; 8986 Enc += ')'; 8987 return true; 8988 } 8989 8990 /// Appends array encoding to Enc before calling appendType for the element. 8991 static bool appendArrayType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QT, 8992 const ArrayType *AT, 8993 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8994 TypeStringCache &TSC, StringRef NoSizeEnc) { 8995 if (AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Normal) 8996 return false; 8997 Enc += "a("; 8998 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 8999 CAT->getSize().toStringUnsigned(Enc); 9000 else 9001 Enc += NoSizeEnc; // Global arrays use "*", otherwise it is "". 9002 Enc += ':'; 9003 // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array. 9004 appendQualifier(Enc, QT); 9005 if (!appendType(Enc, AT->getElementType(), CGM, TSC)) 9006 return false; 9007 Enc += ')'; 9008 return true; 9009 } 9010 9011 /// Appends a function encoding to Enc, calling appendType for the return type 9012 /// and the arguments. 9013 static bool appendFunctionType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const FunctionType *FT, 9014 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 9015 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 9016 Enc += "f{"; 9017 if (!appendType(Enc, FT->getReturnType(), CGM, TSC)) 9018 return false; 9019 Enc += "}("; 9020 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FT->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 9021 // N.B. we are only interested in the adjusted param types. 9022 auto I = FPT->param_type_begin(); 9023 auto E = FPT->param_type_end(); 9024 if (I != E) { 9025 do { 9026 if (!appendType(Enc, *I, CGM, TSC)) 9027 return false; 9028 ++I; 9029 if (I != E) 9030 Enc += ','; 9031 } while (I != E); 9032 if (FPT->isVariadic()) 9033 Enc += ",va"; 9034 } else { 9035 if (FPT->isVariadic()) 9036 Enc += "va"; 9037 else 9038 Enc += '0'; 9039 } 9040 } 9041 Enc += ')'; 9042 return true; 9043 } 9044 9045 /// Handles the type's qualifier before dispatching a call to handle specific 9046 /// type encodings. 9047 static bool appendType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QType, 9048 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 9049 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 9050 9051 QualType QT = QType.getCanonicalType(); 9052 9053 if (const ArrayType *AT = QT->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()) 9054 // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array. 9055 // Thus we don't call appendQualifier() here. 9056 return appendArrayType(Enc, QT, AT, CGM, TSC, ""); 9057 9058 appendQualifier(Enc, QT); 9059 9060 if (const BuiltinType *BT = QT->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 9061 return appendBuiltinType(Enc, BT); 9062 9063 if (const PointerType *PT = QT->getAs<PointerType>()) 9064 return appendPointerType(Enc, PT, CGM, TSC); 9065 9066 if (const EnumType *ET = QT->getAs<EnumType>()) 9067 return appendEnumType(Enc, ET, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier()); 9068 9069 if (const RecordType *RT = QT->getAsStructureType()) 9070 return appendRecordType(Enc, RT, CGM, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier()); 9071 9072 if (const RecordType *RT = QT->getAsUnionType()) 9073 return appendRecordType(Enc, RT, CGM, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier()); 9074 9075 if (const FunctionType *FT = QT->getAs<FunctionType>()) 9076 return appendFunctionType(Enc, FT, CGM, TSC); 9077 9078 return false; 9079 } 9080 9081 static bool getTypeString(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const Decl *D, 9082 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, TypeStringCache &TSC) { 9083 if (!D) 9084 return false; 9085 9086 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 9087 if (FD->getLanguageLinkage() != CLanguageLinkage) 9088 return false; 9089 return appendType(Enc, FD->getType(), CGM, TSC); 9090 } 9091 9092 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 9093 if (VD->getLanguageLinkage() != CLanguageLinkage) 9094 return false; 9095 QualType QT = VD->getType().getCanonicalType(); 9096 if (const ArrayType *AT = QT->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()) { 9097 // Global ArrayTypes are given a size of '*' if the size is unknown. 9098 // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array. 9099 // Thus we don't call appendQualifier() here. 9100 return appendArrayType(Enc, QT, AT, CGM, TSC, "*"); 9101 } 9102 return appendType(Enc, QT, CGM, TSC); 9103 } 9104 return false; 9105 } 9106 9107 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9108 // RISCV ABI Implementation 9109 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9110 9111 namespace { 9112 class RISCVABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 9113 private: 9114 unsigned XLen; // Size of the integer ('x') registers in bits. 9115 static const int NumArgGPRs = 8; 9116 9117 public: 9118 RISCVABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, unsigned XLen) 9119 : DefaultABIInfo(CGT), XLen(XLen) {} 9120 9121 // DefaultABIInfo's classifyReturnType and classifyArgumentType are 9122 // non-virtual, but computeInfo is virtual, so we overload it. 9123 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 9124 9125 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, bool IsFixed, 9126 int &ArgGPRsLeft) const; 9127 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 9128 9129 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 9130 QualType Ty) const override; 9131 9132 ABIArgInfo extendType(QualType Ty) const; 9133 }; 9134 } // end anonymous namespace 9135 9136 void RISCVABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 9137 QualType RetTy = FI.getReturnType(); 9138 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 9139 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(RetTy); 9140 9141 // IsRetIndirect is true if classifyArgumentType indicated the value should 9142 // be passed indirect or if the type size is greater than 2*xlen. e.g. fp128 9143 // is passed direct in LLVM IR, relying on the backend lowering code to 9144 // rewrite the argument list and pass indirectly on RV32. 9145 bool IsRetIndirect = FI.getReturnInfo().getKind() == ABIArgInfo::Indirect || 9146 getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > (2 * XLen); 9147 9148 // We must track the number of GPRs used in order to conform to the RISC-V 9149 // ABI, as integer scalars passed in registers should have signext/zeroext 9150 // when promoted, but are anyext if passed on the stack. As GPR usage is 9151 // different for variadic arguments, we must also track whether we are 9152 // examining a vararg or not. 9153 int ArgGPRsLeft = IsRetIndirect ? NumArgGPRs - 1 : NumArgGPRs; 9154 int NumFixedArgs = FI.getNumRequiredArgs(); 9155 9156 int ArgNum = 0; 9157 for (auto &ArgInfo : FI.arguments()) { 9158 bool IsFixed = ArgNum < NumFixedArgs; 9159 ArgInfo.info = classifyArgumentType(ArgInfo.type, IsFixed, ArgGPRsLeft); 9160 ArgNum++; 9161 } 9162 } 9163 9164 ABIArgInfo RISCVABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, bool IsFixed, 9165 int &ArgGPRsLeft) const { 9166 assert(ArgGPRsLeft <= NumArgGPRs && "Arg GPR tracking underflow"); 9167 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 9168 9169 // Structures with either a non-trivial destructor or a non-trivial 9170 // copy constructor are always passed indirectly. 9171 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) { 9172 if (ArgGPRsLeft) 9173 ArgGPRsLeft -= 1; 9174 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/RAA == 9175 CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 9176 } 9177 9178 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 9179 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 9180 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 9181 9182 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 9183 uint64_t NeededAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty); 9184 bool MustUseStack = false; 9185 // Determine the number of GPRs needed to pass the current argument 9186 // according to the ABI. 2*XLen-aligned varargs are passed in "aligned" 9187 // register pairs, so may consume 3 registers. 9188 int NeededArgGPRs = 1; 9189 if (!IsFixed && NeededAlign == 2 * XLen) 9190 NeededArgGPRs = 2 + (ArgGPRsLeft % 2); 9191 else if (Size > XLen && Size <= 2 * XLen) 9192 NeededArgGPRs = 2; 9193 9194 if (NeededArgGPRs > ArgGPRsLeft) { 9195 MustUseStack = true; 9196 NeededArgGPRs = ArgGPRsLeft; 9197 } 9198 9199 ArgGPRsLeft -= NeededArgGPRs; 9200 9201 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !Ty->isVectorType()) { 9202 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 9203 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 9204 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 9205 9206 // All integral types are promoted to XLen width, unless passed on the 9207 // stack. 9208 if (Size < XLen && Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && !MustUseStack) { 9209 return extendType(Ty); 9210 } 9211 9212 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 9213 } 9214 9215 // Aggregates which are <= 2*XLen will be passed in registers if possible, 9216 // so coerce to integers. 9217 if (Size <= 2 * XLen) { 9218 unsigned Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty); 9219 9220 // Use a single XLen int if possible, 2*XLen if 2*XLen alignment is 9221 // required, and a 2-element XLen array if only XLen alignment is required. 9222 if (Size <= XLen) { 9223 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect( 9224 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), XLen)); 9225 } else if (Alignment == 2 * XLen) { 9226 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect( 9227 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 2 * XLen)); 9228 } else { 9229 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get( 9230 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), XLen), 2)); 9231 } 9232 } 9233 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 9234 } 9235 9236 ABIArgInfo RISCVABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 9237 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 9238 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 9239 9240 int ArgGPRsLeft = 2; 9241 9242 // The rules for return and argument types are the same, so defer to 9243 // classifyArgumentType. 9244 return classifyArgumentType(RetTy, /*IsFixed=*/true, ArgGPRsLeft); 9245 } 9246 9247 Address RISCVABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 9248 QualType Ty) const { 9249 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(XLen / 8); 9250 9251 // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes. 9252 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) { 9253 Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize); 9254 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty)); 9255 return Addr; 9256 } 9257 9258 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> SizeAndAlign = 9259 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 9260 9261 // Arguments bigger than 2*Xlen bytes are passed indirectly. 9262 bool IsIndirect = SizeAndAlign.first > 2 * SlotSize; 9263 9264 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, SizeAndAlign, 9265 SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign=*/true); 9266 } 9267 9268 ABIArgInfo RISCVABIInfo::extendType(QualType Ty) const { 9269 int TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 9270 // RV64 ABI requires unsigned 32 bit integers to be sign extended. 9271 if (XLen == 64 && Ty->isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() && TySize == 32) 9272 return ABIArgInfo::getSignExtend(Ty); 9273 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty); 9274 } 9275 9276 namespace { 9277 class RISCVTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 9278 public: 9279 RISCVTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, unsigned XLen) 9280 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new RISCVABIInfo(CGT, XLen)) {} 9281 9282 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 9283 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 9284 const auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 9285 if (!FD) return; 9286 9287 const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<RISCVInterruptAttr>(); 9288 if (!Attr) 9289 return; 9290 9291 const char *Kind; 9292 switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) { 9293 case RISCVInterruptAttr::user: Kind = "user"; break; 9294 case RISCVInterruptAttr::supervisor: Kind = "supervisor"; break; 9295 case RISCVInterruptAttr::machine: Kind = "machine"; break; 9296 } 9297 9298 auto *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 9299 9300 Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind); 9301 } 9302 }; 9303 } // namespace 9304 9305 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9306 // Driver code 9307 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9308 9309 bool CodeGenModule::supportsCOMDAT() const { 9310 return getTriple().supportsCOMDAT(); 9311 } 9312 9313 const TargetCodeGenInfo &CodeGenModule::getTargetCodeGenInfo() { 9314 if (TheTargetCodeGenInfo) 9315 return *TheTargetCodeGenInfo; 9316 9317 // Helper to set the unique_ptr while still keeping the return value. 9318 auto SetCGInfo = [&](TargetCodeGenInfo *P) -> const TargetCodeGenInfo & { 9319 this->TheTargetCodeGenInfo.reset(P); 9320 return *P; 9321 }; 9322 9323 const llvm::Triple &Triple = getTarget().getTriple(); 9324 switch (Triple.getArch()) { 9325 default: 9326 return SetCGInfo(new DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9327 9328 case llvm::Triple::le32: 9329 return SetCGInfo(new PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9330 case llvm::Triple::mips: 9331 case llvm::Triple::mipsel: 9332 if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::NaCl) 9333 return SetCGInfo(new PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9334 return SetCGInfo(new MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, true)); 9335 9336 case llvm::Triple::mips64: 9337 case llvm::Triple::mips64el: 9338 return SetCGInfo(new MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, false)); 9339 9340 case llvm::Triple::avr: 9341 return SetCGInfo(new AVRTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9342 9343 case llvm::Triple::aarch64: 9344 case llvm::Triple::aarch64_be: { 9345 AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = AArch64ABIInfo::AAPCS; 9346 if (getTarget().getABI() == "darwinpcs") 9347 Kind = AArch64ABIInfo::DarwinPCS; 9348 else if (Triple.isOSWindows()) 9349 return SetCGInfo( 9350 new WindowsAArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AArch64ABIInfo::Win64)); 9351 9352 return SetCGInfo(new AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind)); 9353 } 9354 9355 case llvm::Triple::wasm32: 9356 case llvm::Triple::wasm64: 9357 return SetCGInfo(new WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9358 9359 case llvm::Triple::arm: 9360 case llvm::Triple::armeb: 9361 case llvm::Triple::thumb: 9362 case llvm::Triple::thumbeb: { 9363 if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::Win32) { 9364 return SetCGInfo( 9365 new WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP)); 9366 } 9367 9368 ARMABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS; 9369 StringRef ABIStr = getTarget().getABI(); 9370 if (ABIStr == "apcs-gnu") 9371 Kind = ARMABIInfo::APCS; 9372 else if (ABIStr == "aapcs16") 9373 Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP; 9374 else if (CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "hard" || 9375 (CodeGenOpts.FloatABI != "soft" && 9376 (Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF || 9377 Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF || 9378 Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::EABIHF))) 9379 Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP; 9380 9381 return SetCGInfo(new ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind)); 9382 } 9383 9384 case llvm::Triple::ppc: 9385 return SetCGInfo( 9386 new PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft")); 9387 case llvm::Triple::ppc64: 9388 if (Triple.isOSBinFormatELF()) { 9389 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv1; 9390 if (getTarget().getABI() == "elfv2") 9391 Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv2; 9392 bool HasQPX = getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx"; 9393 bool IsSoftFloat = CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft"; 9394 9395 return SetCGInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind, HasQPX, 9396 IsSoftFloat)); 9397 } else 9398 return SetCGInfo(new PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9399 case llvm::Triple::ppc64le: { 9400 assert(Triple.isOSBinFormatELF() && "PPC64 LE non-ELF not supported!"); 9401 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv2; 9402 if (getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1" || getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx") 9403 Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv1; 9404 bool HasQPX = getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx"; 9405 bool IsSoftFloat = CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft"; 9406 9407 return SetCGInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind, HasQPX, 9408 IsSoftFloat)); 9409 } 9410 9411 case llvm::Triple::nvptx: 9412 case llvm::Triple::nvptx64: 9413 return SetCGInfo(new NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9414 9415 case llvm::Triple::msp430: 9416 return SetCGInfo(new MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9417 9418 case llvm::Triple::riscv32: 9419 return SetCGInfo(new RISCVTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, 32)); 9420 case llvm::Triple::riscv64: 9421 return SetCGInfo(new RISCVTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, 64)); 9422 9423 case llvm::Triple::systemz: { 9424 bool HasVector = getTarget().getABI() == "vector"; 9425 return SetCGInfo(new SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, HasVector)); 9426 } 9427 9428 case llvm::Triple::tce: 9429 case llvm::Triple::tcele: 9430 return SetCGInfo(new TCETargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9431 9432 case llvm::Triple::x86: { 9433 bool IsDarwinVectorABI = Triple.isOSDarwin(); 9434 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI = 9435 X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI(Triple, CodeGenOpts); 9436 bool IsWin32FloatStructABI = Triple.isOSWindows() && !Triple.isOSCygMing(); 9437 9438 if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::Win32) { 9439 return SetCGInfo(new WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo( 9440 Types, IsDarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, 9441 IsWin32FloatStructABI, CodeGenOpts.NumRegisterParameters)); 9442 } else { 9443 return SetCGInfo(new X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo( 9444 Types, IsDarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, 9445 IsWin32FloatStructABI, CodeGenOpts.NumRegisterParameters, 9446 CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft")); 9447 } 9448 } 9449 9450 case llvm::Triple::x86_64: { 9451 StringRef ABI = getTarget().getABI(); 9452 X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel = 9453 (ABI == "avx512" 9454 ? X86AVXABILevel::AVX512 9455 : ABI == "avx" ? X86AVXABILevel::AVX : X86AVXABILevel::None); 9456 9457 switch (Triple.getOS()) { 9458 case llvm::Triple::Win32: 9459 return SetCGInfo(new WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel)); 9460 case llvm::Triple::PS4: 9461 return SetCGInfo(new PS4TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel)); 9462 default: 9463 return SetCGInfo(new X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel)); 9464 } 9465 } 9466 case llvm::Triple::hexagon: 9467 return SetCGInfo(new HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9468 case llvm::Triple::lanai: 9469 return SetCGInfo(new LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9470 case llvm::Triple::r600: 9471 return SetCGInfo(new AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9472 case llvm::Triple::amdgcn: 9473 return SetCGInfo(new AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9474 case llvm::Triple::sparc: 9475 return SetCGInfo(new SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9476 case llvm::Triple::sparcv9: 9477 return SetCGInfo(new SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9478 case llvm::Triple::xcore: 9479 return SetCGInfo(new XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9480 case llvm::Triple::arc: 9481 return SetCGInfo(new ARCTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9482 case llvm::Triple::spir: 9483 case llvm::Triple::spir64: 9484 return SetCGInfo(new SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 9485 } 9486 } 9487 9488 /// Create an OpenCL kernel for an enqueued block. 9489 /// 9490 /// The kernel has the same function type as the block invoke function. Its 9491 /// name is the name of the block invoke function postfixed with "_kernel". 9492 /// It simply calls the block invoke function then returns. 9493 llvm::Function * 9494 TargetCodeGenInfo::createEnqueuedBlockKernel(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 9495 llvm::Function *Invoke, 9496 llvm::Value *BlockLiteral) const { 9497 auto *InvokeFT = Invoke->getFunctionType(); 9498 llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 2> ArgTys; 9499 for (auto &P : InvokeFT->params()) 9500 ArgTys.push_back(P); 9501 auto &C = CGF.getLLVMContext(); 9502 std::string Name = Invoke->getName().str() + "_kernel"; 9503 auto *FT = llvm::FunctionType::get(llvm::Type::getVoidTy(C), ArgTys, false); 9504 auto *F = llvm::Function::Create(FT, llvm::GlobalValue::InternalLinkage, Name, 9505 &CGF.CGM.getModule()); 9506 auto IP = CGF.Builder.saveIP(); 9507 auto *BB = llvm::BasicBlock::Create(C, "entry", F); 9508 auto &Builder = CGF.Builder; 9509 Builder.SetInsertPoint(BB); 9510 llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Value *, 2> Args; 9511 for (auto &A : F->args()) 9512 Args.push_back(&A); 9513 Builder.CreateCall(Invoke, Args); 9514 Builder.CreateRetVoid(); 9515 Builder.restoreIP(IP); 9516 return F; 9517 } 9518 9519 /// Create an OpenCL kernel for an enqueued block. 9520 /// 9521 /// The type of the first argument (the block literal) is the struct type 9522 /// of the block literal instead of a pointer type. The first argument 9523 /// (block literal) is passed directly by value to the kernel. The kernel 9524 /// allocates the same type of struct on stack and stores the block literal 9525 /// to it and passes its pointer to the block invoke function. The kernel 9526 /// has "enqueued-block" function attribute and kernel argument metadata. 9527 llvm::Function *AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::createEnqueuedBlockKernel( 9528 CodeGenFunction &CGF, llvm::Function *Invoke, 9529 llvm::Value *BlockLiteral) const { 9530 auto &Builder = CGF.Builder; 9531 auto &C = CGF.getLLVMContext(); 9532 9533 auto *BlockTy = BlockLiteral->getType()->getPointerElementType(); 9534 auto *InvokeFT = Invoke->getFunctionType(); 9535 llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 2> ArgTys; 9536 llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> AddressQuals; 9537 llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> AccessQuals; 9538 llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> ArgTypeNames; 9539 llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> ArgBaseTypeNames; 9540 llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> ArgTypeQuals; 9541 llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> ArgNames; 9542 9543 ArgTys.push_back(BlockTy); 9544 ArgTypeNames.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "__block_literal")); 9545 AddressQuals.push_back(llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(Builder.getInt32(0))); 9546 ArgBaseTypeNames.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "__block_literal")); 9547 ArgTypeQuals.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "")); 9548 AccessQuals.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "none")); 9549 ArgNames.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "block_literal")); 9550 for (unsigned I = 1, E = InvokeFT->getNumParams(); I < E; ++I) { 9551 ArgTys.push_back(InvokeFT->getParamType(I)); 9552 ArgTypeNames.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "void*")); 9553 AddressQuals.push_back(llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(Builder.getInt32(3))); 9554 AccessQuals.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "none")); 9555 ArgBaseTypeNames.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "void*")); 9556 ArgTypeQuals.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "")); 9557 ArgNames.push_back( 9558 llvm::MDString::get(C, (Twine("local_arg") + Twine(I)).str())); 9559 } 9560 std::string Name = Invoke->getName().str() + "_kernel"; 9561 auto *FT = llvm::FunctionType::get(llvm::Type::getVoidTy(C), ArgTys, false); 9562 auto *F = llvm::Function::Create(FT, llvm::GlobalValue::InternalLinkage, Name, 9563 &CGF.CGM.getModule()); 9564 F->addFnAttr("enqueued-block"); 9565 auto IP = CGF.Builder.saveIP(); 9566 auto *BB = llvm::BasicBlock::Create(C, "entry", F); 9567 Builder.SetInsertPoint(BB); 9568 unsigned BlockAlign = CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().getPrefTypeAlignment(BlockTy); 9569 auto *BlockPtr = Builder.CreateAlloca(BlockTy, nullptr); 9570 BlockPtr->setAlignment(BlockAlign); 9571 Builder.CreateAlignedStore(F->arg_begin(), BlockPtr, BlockAlign); 9572 auto *Cast = Builder.CreatePointerCast(BlockPtr, InvokeFT->getParamType(0)); 9573 llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Value *, 2> Args; 9574 Args.push_back(Cast); 9575 for (auto I = F->arg_begin() + 1, E = F->arg_end(); I != E; ++I) 9576 Args.push_back(I); 9577 Builder.CreateCall(Invoke, Args); 9578 Builder.CreateRetVoid(); 9579 Builder.restoreIP(IP); 9580 9581 F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_addr_space", llvm::MDNode::get(C, AddressQuals)); 9582 F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_access_qual", llvm::MDNode::get(C, AccessQuals)); 9583 F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_type", llvm::MDNode::get(C, ArgTypeNames)); 9584 F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_base_type", 9585 llvm::MDNode::get(C, ArgBaseTypeNames)); 9586 F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_type_qual", llvm::MDNode::get(C, ArgTypeQuals)); 9587 if (CGF.CGM.getCodeGenOpts().EmitOpenCLArgMetadata) 9588 F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_name", llvm::MDNode::get(C, ArgNames)); 9589 9590 return F; 9591 } 9592